]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/gcc.git/blame - gcc/doc/tm.texi
target.def (rtx_costs): Remove "code" param, add "mode".
[thirdparty/gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi
CommitLineData
5624e564 1@c Copyright (C) 1988-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
feca2ed3
JW
2@c This is part of the GCC manual.
3@c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
4
5@node Target Macros
672a6f42 6@chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
feca2ed3
JW
7@cindex machine description macros
8@cindex target description macros
9@cindex macros, target description
10@cindex @file{tm.h} macros
11
12In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
13includes a C header file conventionally given the name
672a6f42
NB
14@file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
15The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
16about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
17@file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
18@file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
19@file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
648c546a 20source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
672a6f42
NB
21containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
22machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
23if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
24through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
feca2ed3
JW
25
26@menu
648c546a 27* Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
feca2ed3 28* Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
630d3d5a 29* Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
414c4dc4 30* Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
feca2ed3
JW
31* Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
32* Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
33* Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
34* Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
35* Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
6ccde948 36* Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
feca2ed3
JW
37* Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
38* Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
39* Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
aacd3885 40* Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
feca2ed3
JW
41* Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
42* Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
c237e94a 43* Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
feca2ed3 44* Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
6ccde948 45* PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
feca2ed3
JW
46* Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
47* Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
b216cd4a 48* Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
9f09b1f2 49* Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
91d231cb 50* Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
feb60f03 51* Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
d604bca3 52* MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
7bb1ad93 53* PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
4185ae53 54* C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
09e881c9 55* Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
feca2ed3
JW
56* Misc:: Everything else.
57@end menu
58
672a6f42 59@node Target Structure
648c546a 60@section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
672a6f42
NB
61@cindex target hooks
62@cindex target functions
63
f6897b10
SS
64@deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
65The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
672a6f42
NB
66which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
67machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
68@file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
69used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
70for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
71macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
72@smallexample
73#include "target.h"
74#include "target-def.h"
75
76/* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
77
91d231cb
JM
78#undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
79#define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
672a6f42 80
f6897b10 81struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
672a6f42
NB
82@end smallexample
83@end deftypevar
84
85Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
648c546a 86form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
672a6f42
NB
87``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
88from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
648c546a 89@code{targetm} structure.
672a6f42 90
acce4e77
JM
91Similarly, there is a @code{targetcm} variable for hooks that are
92specific to front ends for C-family languages, documented as ``C
93Target Hook''. This is declared in @file{c-family/c-target.h}, the
dd5a833e 94initializer @code{TARGETCM_INITIALIZER} in
acce4e77
JM
95@file{c-family/c-target-def.h}. If targets initialize @code{targetcm}
96themselves, they should set @code{target_has_targetcm=yes} in
97@file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default definition is used.
98
c49a6962
JM
99Similarly, there is a @code{targetm_common} variable for hooks that
100are shared between the compiler driver and the compilers proper,
101documented as ``Common Target Hook''. This is declared in
102@file{common/common-target.h}, the initializer
103@code{TARGETM_COMMON_INITIALIZER} in
104@file{common/common-target-def.h}. If targets initialize
105@code{targetm_common} themselves, they should set
106@code{target_has_targetm_common=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a
107default definition is used.
108
feca2ed3
JW
109@node Driver
110@section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
111@cindex driver
112@cindex controlling the compilation driver
113
114@c prevent bad page break with this line
115You can control the compilation driver.
116
a2c4f8e0 117@defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
db36994b
RS
118A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
119initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
120
3bd6d4c4
AO
121The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
122default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
123choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
124applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
125options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
126using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
db36994b
RS
127
128This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
129options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
130that the other specs are easier to write.
131
132Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 133@end defmac
db36994b 134
a2c4f8e0 135@defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
7816bea0
DJ
136A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
137@option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
138for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
139outermost pair of surrounding braces.
140
141The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
142the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
143to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
144@samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
145everywhere it occurs.
146
147The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
148default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
149the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
150
151Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 152@end defmac
7816bea0 153
a2c4f8e0 154@defmac CPP_SPEC
a3a15b4d 155A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
161d7b59
JM
156pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
157give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
feca2ed3
JW
158
159Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 160@end defmac
feca2ed3 161
a2c4f8e0 162@defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
a9374841 163This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
161d7b59 164than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
a9374841 165@code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
a2c4f8e0 166@end defmac
a9374841 167
a2c4f8e0 168@defmac CC1_SPEC
a3a15b4d 169A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
66519c70
JL
170pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
171front ends.
a3a15b4d 172It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
630d3d5a 173for GCC to pass to front ends.
feca2ed3
JW
174
175Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 176@end defmac
feca2ed3 177
a2c4f8e0 178@defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
a3a15b4d 179A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
feca2ed3 180pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
a3a15b4d 181give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
feca2ed3
JW
182
183Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
1d96e5b4
FF
184Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
185@code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
161d7b59 186CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
a2c4f8e0 187@end defmac
feca2ed3 188
a2c4f8e0 189@defmac ASM_SPEC
a3a15b4d 190A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
feca2ed3 191pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
a3a15b4d 192you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
feca2ed3
JW
193See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
194
195Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 196@end defmac
feca2ed3 197
a2c4f8e0 198@defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
a3a15b4d 199A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
feca2ed3
JW
200run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
201Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
202an example of this.
203
204Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 205@end defmac
feca2ed3 206
a2c4f8e0 207@defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
4977bab6
ZW
208Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
209an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
210read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
211output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
212@option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
213
214If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
215standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
216cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
217see @file{mips.h} for instance.
a2c4f8e0 218@end defmac
4977bab6 219
a2c4f8e0 220@defmac LINK_SPEC
a3a15b4d 221A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
feca2ed3 222pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
a3a15b4d 223give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
feca2ed3
JW
224
225Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 226@end defmac
feca2ed3 227
a2c4f8e0 228@defmac LIB_SPEC
feca2ed3
JW
229Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
230between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
231command given to the linker.
232
233If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
234loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
a2c4f8e0 235@end defmac
feca2ed3 236
a2c4f8e0 237@defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
a3a15b4d 238Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
feca2ed3
JW
239how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
240linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
241the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
242
a3a15b4d 243If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
630d3d5a 244passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
a2c4f8e0 245@end defmac
feca2ed3 246
328163dc
MA
247@defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
248By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
249@code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
250instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
4ec7afd7
KH
251depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
252@option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
328163dc
MA
253targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
254@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
255driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
256line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
257@end defmac
258
743eeb5a
AM
259@defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
260A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
261mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
e927b6ad
RO
262generated that uses @option{--as-needed} or equivalent options and the
263shared @file{libgcc} in place of the
743eeb5a
AM
264static exception handler library, when linking without any of
265@code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
266@end defmac
267
268@defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
269If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
270When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
271the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
272@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
273@end defmac
274
a2c4f8e0 275@defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
feca2ed3
JW
276Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
277difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
278the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
279
280If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
281standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
a2c4f8e0 282@end defmac
feca2ed3 283
a2c4f8e0 284@defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
feca2ed3
JW
285Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
286difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
287the very end of the command given to the linker.
288
289Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 290@end defmac
feca2ed3 291
a2c4f8e0 292@defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
008355a6
AO
293GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
294However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
295models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
296@code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
297blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
298default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
299@code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
a2c4f8e0 300@end defmac
008355a6 301
a2c4f8e0 302@defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
73774972
EC
303Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
304configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
305et al, within sysroot+suffix.
a2c4f8e0 306@end defmac
e7f13528 307
a2c4f8e0 308@defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
73774972
EC
309Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
310GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
f4314bb6 311updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
e7f13528 312usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
a2c4f8e0 313@end defmac
e7f13528 314
a2c4f8e0 315@defmac EXTRA_SPECS
feca2ed3
JW
316Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
317@file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
318@code{CC1_SPEC}.
319
320The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
321containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
322string constant that provides the specification.
323
324Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
325
326@code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
630d3d5a 327related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
feca2ed3
JW
328to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
329these definitions.
330
331For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
332define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
333used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
334used.
335
336The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
337
3ab51846 338@smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
339#define EXTRA_SPECS \
340 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
341
342#define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
3ab51846 343@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
344
345The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
346@smallexample
347#undef CPP_SPEC
348#define CPP_SPEC \
349"%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
50d440bc
NC
350%@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
351%@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
feca2ed3
JW
352%@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
353
354#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
355#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
356@end smallexample
357
358while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
359@code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
360
361@smallexample
362#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
363#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
364@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 365@end defmac
feca2ed3 366
a2c4f8e0 367@defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
feca2ed3
JW
368Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
369@file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
630d3d5a 370the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
a2c4f8e0 371@end defmac
feca2ed3 372
a2c4f8e0 373@defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
bbd7687d
DM
374The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
375By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
a2c4f8e0 376@end defmac
bbd7687d 377
a2c4f8e0 378@defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
9ec36da5
JL
379A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
380linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
381change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
382define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
383line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
bbd7687d
DM
384the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
385@code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
a2c4f8e0 386@end defmac
9ec36da5 387
c49a6962
JM
388@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALWAYS_STRIP_DOTDOT
389True if @file{..} components should always be removed from directory names computed relative to GCC's internal directories, false (default) if such components should be preserved and directory names containing them passed to other tools such as the linker.
390@end deftypevr
391
a2c4f8e0 392@defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
feca2ed3
JW
393Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
394string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
395target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
396@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
397
398Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
399the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
400@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
401@xref{Target Fragment}.
a2c4f8e0 402@end defmac
feca2ed3 403
a2c4f8e0 404@defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
05739753 405Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
630d3d5a 406a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
feca2ed3 407indicates an absolute file name.
a2c4f8e0 408@end defmac
feca2ed3 409
a2c4f8e0 410@defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
feca2ed3
JW
411If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
412@code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
1401cf37 413when the compiler is built as a cross
5505263f
JL
414compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
415to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
a2c4f8e0 416@end defmac
feca2ed3 417
a2c4f8e0 418@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
feca2ed3 419Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
0d037580 420standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
feca2ed3 421try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
0d037580
DJ
422@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
423is built as a cross compiler.
a2c4f8e0 424@end defmac
feca2ed3 425
656c7a3a
AL
426@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
427Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
428standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
429when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
430@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
431is built as a cross compiler.
432@end defmac
433
434@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
435Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
436standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
437default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
438@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
439is built as a cross compiler.
440@end defmac
441
a2c4f8e0 442@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
feca2ed3
JW
443If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
444standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
1401cf37 445compiler is built as a cross compiler.
a2c4f8e0 446@end defmac
feca2ed3 447
a2c4f8e0 448@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
feca2ed3 449If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
1401cf37
MLI
450standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
451cross compiler.
a2c4f8e0 452@end defmac
feca2ed3 453
a2c4f8e0 454@defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
e9a25f70 455Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
feca2ed3
JW
456variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
457loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
458initialize the necessary environment variables.
a2c4f8e0 459@end defmac
feca2ed3 460
a2c4f8e0 461@defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
feca2ed3
JW
462Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
463standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
464try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
08b2bad2
SB
465comes before @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR} (set in
466@file{config.gcc}, normally @file{/usr/include}) in the search order.
feca2ed3 467
c237e94a
ZW
468Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
469replacement.
a2c4f8e0 470@end defmac
feca2ed3 471
08b2bad2
SB
472@defmac NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_COMPONENT
473The ``component'' corresponding to @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}.
e9a25f70
JL
474See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
475If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
a2c4f8e0 476@end defmac
e9a25f70 477
a2c4f8e0 478@defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
feca2ed3 479Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
e9a25f70
JL
480for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
481usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
08b2bad2
SB
482@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
483@code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
feca2ed3 484and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
161d7b59 485and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
feca2ed3
JW
486@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
487
488The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
e9a25f70 489Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
9f6dc500
HPN
490string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
491for C++-only directories,
e9a25f70
JL
492and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
493wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
494the array with a null element.
495
496The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
4bd0bee9 497if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
9f6dc500 498or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
e9a25f70
JL
499operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
500
e9a25f70 501For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
feca2ed3 502
3ab51846 503@smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
504#define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
505@{ \
e9a25f70
JL
506 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
507 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
508 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
509 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
510 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
feca2ed3 511@}
3ab51846 512@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 513@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
514
515Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
516
517@enumerate
518@item
630d3d5a 519Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
feca2ed3
JW
520
521@item
fe037b8a 522The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
ff2ce160 523is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
fe037b8a 524@var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
feca2ed3
JW
525
526@item
527The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
528
529@item
fe037b8a 530The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
ff2ce160 531in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
feca2ed3
JW
532
533@item
ff2ce160 534The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
feca2ed3
JW
535
536@item
ff2ce160 537The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
fe037b8a
CD
538
539@item
ff2ce160 540The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
fe037b8a 541compiler.
feca2ed3
JW
542@end enumerate
543
544Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
545
546@enumerate
547@item
630d3d5a 548Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
feca2ed3
JW
549
550@item
fe037b8a
CD
551The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
552value based on the installed toolchain location.
feca2ed3
JW
553
554@item
555The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
512b62fb 556(or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
feca2ed3
JW
557
558@item
fe037b8a 559The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
ff2ce160 560in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
feca2ed3
JW
561
562@item
fe037b8a
CD
563The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
564
565@item
ff2ce160 566The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
fe037b8a 567compiler.
feca2ed3
JW
568
569@item
ff2ce160 570The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
fe037b8a 571native compiler, or we have a target system root.
feca2ed3
JW
572
573@item
ff2ce160 574The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
fe037b8a 575native compiler, or we have a target system root.
feca2ed3
JW
576
577@item
fe037b8a
CD
578The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
579If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
580the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
feca2ed3
JW
581
582@item
fe037b8a
CD
583The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
584compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
feca2ed3
JW
585@file{/lib/}.
586
587@item
fe037b8a
CD
588The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
589compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
feca2ed3
JW
590@file{/usr/lib/}.
591@end enumerate
592
593@node Run-time Target
594@section Run-time Target Specification
595@cindex run-time target specification
596@cindex predefined macros
597@cindex target specifications
598
599@c prevent bad page break with this line
600Here are run-time target specifications.
601
a2c4f8e0 602@defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
12a41c22 603This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
44082375 604built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
1f95326c 605the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
cb60f38d 606@code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
12a41c22
NB
607calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
608finished command line option processing your code can use those
609results freely.
3df89291
NB
610
611@code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
612command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
d90a95fb 613the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
3df89291
NB
614accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
615
d90a95fb 616@code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
3df89291 617object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
d90a95fb 618@code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
3df89291
NB
619defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
620with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
621only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
622example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
623and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
624@code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
625defines only @code{_ABI64}.
626
e0322d5c
NB
627You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
628@code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
629or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
630assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
631macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
ce3649d2 632to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
c219e1da
JDA
633variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
634@code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
635preprocessing.
a2c4f8e0 636@end defmac
e0322d5c 637
a2c4f8e0 638@defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
12a41c22
NB
639Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
640and is used for the target operating system instead.
a2c4f8e0 641@end defmac
12a41c22 642
a2c4f8e0 643@defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
4e2e315f
NB
644Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
645and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
646macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
647it yourself.
a2c4f8e0 648@end defmac
4e2e315f 649
a2c4f8e0 650@deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
75685792
RS
651This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
652any target-specific headers.
a2c4f8e0 653@end deftypevar
feca2ed3 654
677f3fa8 655@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} int TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
75685792
RS
656This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
657Its default setting is 0.
9e3be889 658@end deftypevr
75685792 659
bacf5b96
RS
660@cindex optional hardware or system features
661@cindex features, optional, in system conventions
662
677f3fa8 663@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts_set}, const struct cl_decoded_option *@var{decoded}, location_t @var{loc})
75685792
RS
664This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
665target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
666(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
667processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
668definition does nothing but return true.
669
96e45421
JM
670@var{decoded} specifies the option and its arguments. @var{opts} and
671@var{opts_set} are the @code{gcc_options} structures to be used for
672storing option state, and @var{loc} is the location at which the
673option was passed (@code{UNKNOWN_LOCATION} except for options passed
674via attributes).
75685792
RS
675@end deftypefn
676
acce4e77 677@deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION (size_t @var{code}, const char *@var{arg}, int @var{value})
1f1d5130
MS
678This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
679target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
680definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
681option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
7a241624
JR
682valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
683default definition does nothing but return false.
1f1d5130
MS
684
685In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
686options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
687only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
688should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
689@end deftypefn
690
acce4e77 691@deftypefn {C Target Hook} tree TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT (tree @var{string})
91ebb981
IS
692Targets may provide a string object type that can be used within and between C, C++ and their respective Objective-C dialects. A string object might, for example, embed encoding and length information. These objects are considered opaque to the compiler and handled as references. An ideal implementation makes the composition of the string object match that of the Objective-C @code{NSString} (@code{NXString} for GNUStep), allowing efficient interworking between C-only and Objective-C code. If a target implements string objects then this hook should return a reference to such an object constructed from the normal `C' string representation provided in @var{string}. At present, the hook is used by Objective-C only, to obtain a common-format string object when the target provides one.
693@end deftypefn
694
70f42967
SB
695@deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_CLASS_REFERENCE (const char *@var{classname})
696Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is referenced by the current TU.
697@end deftypefn
698
699@deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_CLASS_DEFINITION (const char *@var{classname})
700Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is defined by the current TU.
701@end deftypefn
702
acce4e77 703@deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P (const_tree @var{stringref})
91ebb981
IS
704If a target implements string objects then this hook should return @code{true} if @var{stringref} is a valid reference to such an object.
705@end deftypefn
706
acce4e77 707@deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG (tree @var{format_arg}, tree @var{args_list})
91ebb981 708If a target implements string objects then this hook should should provide a facility to check the function arguments in @var{args_list} against the format specifiers in @var{format_arg} where the type of @var{format_arg} is one recognized as a valid string reference type.
26705988
IS
709@end deftypefn
710
2b7e2984 711@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE (void)
74f7912a 712This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
2b7e2984
SE
713but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
714pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
715attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
74f7912a
JR
716when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
717actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
2b7e2984
SE
718@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
719@end deftypefn
720
c7b5e395 721@defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
c5387660
JM
722This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
723but is only used in the C
c7b5e395
GK
724language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
725used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
726frontends.
727@end defmac
728
677f3fa8 729@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} {const struct default_options *} TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
feca2ed3 730Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
3020190e
JM
731various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
732options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
733options are processed once
feca2ed3 734just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
3020190e 735of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
2b0d3573 736options passed explicitly.
feca2ed3 737
3020190e 738This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
a51fa0f4
MM
739options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
740@code{optimize} attribute.
3020190e 741@end deftypevr
feca2ed3 742
677f3fa8 743@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
7e4aae92
JM
744Set target-dependent initial values of fields in @var{opts}.
745@end deftypefn
746
4c77620d 747@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS (void)
128dc8e2
JM
748Set target-dependent default values for @option{--param} settings, using calls to @code{set_default_param_value}.
749@end deftypefn
750
3bd36029
RS
751@defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
752Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
753during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
754the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
755can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
756and @code{nomips16} attributes.
757
758Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
759registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
760operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
761in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
762significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
763for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
764switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
765
766Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
767is 0.
768@end defmac
769
9193fb05
JM
770@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FLOAT_EXCEPTIONS_ROUNDING_SUPPORTED_P (void)
771Returns true if the target supports IEEE 754 floating-point exceptions and rounding modes, false otherwise. This is intended to relate to the @code{float} and @code{double} types, but not necessarily @code{long double}. By default, returns true if the @code{adddf3} instruction pattern is available and false otherwise, on the assumption that hardware floating point supports exceptions and rounding modes but software floating point does not.
772@end deftypefn
773
414c4dc4
NC
774@node Per-Function Data
775@section Defining data structures for per-function information.
776@cindex per-function data
777@cindex data structures
778
779If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
780provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
781using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
782nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
783when another one comes along.
784
785GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
786contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
787structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
788@code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
789to their own specific data.
790
791If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
e2500fed
GK
792@code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
793This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
794@code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
414c4dc4
NC
795
796One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
797RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
798RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
799function, for level 0.
800
aee96fe9 801Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
414c4dc4
NC
802all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
803function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
804stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
805stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
02f52e19 806@code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
414c4dc4
NC
807the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
808single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
809longer supported.
810
a2c4f8e0 811@defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
c21cd8b1 812Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
414c4dc4 813is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
c21cd8b1 814The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
a2c4f8e0
ZW
815function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
816@end defmac
414c4dc4 817
a2c4f8e0
ZW
818@deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
819If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
820function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
821target to perform any target specific initialization of the
822@code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
823used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
414c4dc4 824
8a36672b 825@code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
e2500fed 826Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
a9429e29 827GC allocation, including the structure itself.
a2c4f8e0 828@end deftypevar
414c4dc4 829
feca2ed3
JW
830@node Storage Layout
831@section Storage Layout
832@cindex storage layout
833
834Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
835alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
836expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
837@xref{Run-time Target}.
838
a2c4f8e0 839@defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
feca2ed3
JW
840Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
841byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
842This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
843bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
844be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
845macro need not be a constant.
846
847This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
848bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
a2c4f8e0 849@end defmac
feca2ed3 850
a2c4f8e0 851@defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
feca2ed3
JW
852Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
853word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
a2c4f8e0 854@end defmac
feca2ed3 855
a2c4f8e0 856@defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
feca2ed3
JW
857Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
858most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
c0a6a1ef
BS
859memory locations and registers; see @code{REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} if the
860order of words in memory is not the same as the order in registers. This
feca2ed3 861macro need not be a constant.
a2c4f8e0 862@end defmac
feca2ed3 863
c0a6a1ef
BS
864@defmac REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
865On some machines, the order of words in a multiword object differs between
866registers in memory. In such a situation, define this macro to describe
867the order of words in a register. The macro @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} controls
868the order of words in memory.
869@end defmac
870
a2c4f8e0 871@defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
feca2ed3
JW
872Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
873@code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
874containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
875have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
876
877You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
878multi-word integers.
a2c4f8e0 879@end defmac
feca2ed3 880
a2c4f8e0 881@defmac BITS_PER_WORD
e81dd381
KG
882Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
883is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
a2c4f8e0 884@end defmac
feca2ed3 885
a2c4f8e0 886@defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
feca2ed3
JW
887Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
888@code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
889largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
a2c4f8e0 890@end defmac
feca2ed3 891
a2c4f8e0 892@defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
c4336539
PB
893Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
894register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
a2c4f8e0 895@end defmac
feca2ed3 896
a2c4f8e0 897@defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
feca2ed3
JW
898Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
899@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
900smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
a2c4f8e0 901@end defmac
feca2ed3 902
a2c4f8e0 903@defmac POINTER_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
904Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
905width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
2465bf76
KG
906you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
907a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
a2c4f8e0 908@end defmac
feca2ed3 909
a2c4f8e0 910@defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
4923a230
RS
911A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
912@code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
913greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
914should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
915is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
916@code{ptr_extend} instruction.
917
918You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
919and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
a2c4f8e0 920@end defmac
feca2ed3 921
a2c4f8e0 922@defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
feca2ed3
JW
923A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
924is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
925stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
926scalar type.
927
928On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
929register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
930@var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
931cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
932floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
933counterparts.
934
935For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
936However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
937either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
938the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
939sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
940@var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
941
942Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
a2c4f8e0 943@end defmac
feca2ed3 944
ef4bddc2 945@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE (const_tree @var{type}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int *@var{punsignedp}, const_tree @var{funtype}, int @var{for_return})
cde0f3fd
PB
946Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
947function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
948and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
949change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
950pointer} types.
951
666e3ceb
PB
952@var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
953return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
954@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
955If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
956which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
957then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
958the signedness may be different.
959
5e617be8
AK
960@var{type} can be NULL when promoting function arguments of libcalls.
961
cde0f3fd
PB
962The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
963also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
964if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
61f71b34 965@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 966
a2c4f8e0 967@defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
feca2ed3
JW
968Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
969bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
970regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
971size of an integer.
a2c4f8e0 972@end defmac
feca2ed3 973
a2c4f8e0 974@defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
31cdd499
ZW
975Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
976stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
977desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
978if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
979this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
a2c4f8e0 980@end defmac
c795bca9 981
a2c4f8e0 982@defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
31cdd499
ZW
983Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
984stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
985is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
986macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
987@code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
a2c4f8e0 988@end defmac
feca2ed3 989
2e3f842f
L
990@defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
991Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
992from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
993to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
994@end defmac
995
a2c4f8e0 996@defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
feca2ed3 997Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
a2c4f8e0 998@end defmac
feca2ed3 999
a2c4f8e0 1000@defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
c4f46fde
DD
1001Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1002bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1003just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
a2c4f8e0 1004@end defmac
feca2ed3 1005
6d2b7199
BS
1006@deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_ABSOLUTE_BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1007If defined, this target hook specifies the absolute biggest alignment
1008that a type or variable can have on this machine, otherwise,
1009@code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} is used.
1010@end deftypevr
1011
95331614
OH
1012@defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1013Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1014provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1015@end defmac
1016
6e4f1168
L
1017@defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1018Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1019not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1020@end defmac
1021
a2c4f8e0 1022@defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
861bb6c1
JL
1023If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1024object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1025nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1026on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
a2c4f8e0 1027@end defmac
861bb6c1 1028
a2c4f8e0 1029@defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
11cf4d18
JJ
1030Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1031machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1032structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1033by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
a2c4f8e0 1034@end defmac
feca2ed3 1035
a2c4f8e0 1036@defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
feca2ed3 1037An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
ad9335eb
JJ
1038alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1039@code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1040alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1041field alignment has not been set by the
1042@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
a2c4f8e0 1043@end defmac
feca2ed3 1044
2e3f842f
L
1045@defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1046Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1047to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1048
1049If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1050
1051@c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1052@c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1053@c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1054@c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1055@end defmac
1056
a2c4f8e0 1057@defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
feca2ed3
JW
1058Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1059Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1060@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1061the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
11d90e2d
CD
1062
1063On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1064the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
a9243bfc 1065a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((uint64_t) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
11d90e2d
CD
1066On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1067@samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
a2c4f8e0 1068@end defmac
feca2ed3 1069
a2c4f8e0 1070@defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
a8d1550a 1071If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
8a198bd2
JW
1072the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1073the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
feca2ed3
JW
1074macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1075
1076If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1077
1078@findex strcpy
1079One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1080make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1081arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1082constants to character arrays can be done inline.
a2c4f8e0 1083@end defmac
feca2ed3 1084
df8a1d28
JJ
1085@defmac DATA_ABI_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1086Similar to @code{DATA_ALIGNMENT}, but for the cases where the ABI mandates
1087some alignment increase, instead of optimization only purposes. E.g.@
1088AMD x86-64 psABI says that variables with array type larger than 15 bytes
1089must be aligned to 16 byte boundaries.
1090
1091If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1092@end defmac
1093
a2c4f8e0 1094@defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
feca2ed3
JW
1095If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1096that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1097@var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1098have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1099align the object.
1100
1101If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1102
1103The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1104constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1105constants can be done inline.
a2c4f8e0 1106@end defmac
feca2ed3 1107
a2c4f8e0 1108@defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
a8d1550a 1109If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
d16790f2
JW
1110the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1111the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1112macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1113
1114If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1115
1116One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1117make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
4a6336ad 1118
64ad7c99 1119If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
a2c4f8e0 1120@end defmac
d16790f2 1121
5aea1e76
UW
1122@deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT (const_tree @var{type})
1123This hook can be used to define the alignment for a vector of type
1124@var{type}, in order to comply with a platform ABI. The default is to
1125require natural alignment for vector types. The alignment returned by
1126this hook must be a power-of-two multiple of the default alignment of
1127the vector element type.
1128@end deftypefn
1129
76fe54f0
L
1130@defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1131If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1132@var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1133and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1134have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1135align the slot.
1136
1137If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1138@var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1139be used.
1140
1141This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1142of all possible modes which the slot may have.
4a6336ad 1143
64ad7c99 1144If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
76fe54f0
L
1145@end defmac
1146
9bfaf89d
JJ
1147@defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1148If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1149variable @var{decl}.
1150
1151If this macro is not defined, then
1152@code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1153is used.
1154
1155One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1156make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
4a6336ad 1157
64ad7c99 1158If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
9bfaf89d
JJ
1159@end defmac
1160
ae58e548
JJ
1161@defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1162If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1163for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1164@var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1165
1166If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1167@end defmac
1168
a2c4f8e0 1169@defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
c771326b 1170Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
feca2ed3
JW
1171empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1172
78d55cc8 1173If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
a2c4f8e0 1174@end defmac
feca2ed3 1175
a2c4f8e0 1176@defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
feca2ed3
JW
1177Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1178Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1179
1180If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1181@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
a2c4f8e0 1182@end defmac
feca2ed3 1183
a2c4f8e0 1184@defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
feca2ed3
JW
1185Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1186if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1187go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
a2c4f8e0 1188@end defmac
feca2ed3 1189
a2c4f8e0 1190@defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
feca2ed3 1191Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
c771326b 1192alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
feca2ed3 1193
8dc65b6e
MM
1194The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1195@code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1196structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1197that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1198that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1199
1200Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1201@code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1202four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1203not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1204
1205An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1206structure.
feca2ed3
JW
1207
1208If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1209a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1210
1211Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
c771326b 1212bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
feca2ed3
JW
1213support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1214@samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1215
c771326b 1216The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
feca2ed3
JW
1217@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1218Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1219
c771326b 1220Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
feca2ed3
JW
1221@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1222@code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1223
a3a15b4d 1224If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
c771326b 1225bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
feca2ed3
JW
1226what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1227
3ab51846 1228@smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
1229struct foo1
1230@{
1231 char x;
1232 char :0;
1233 char y;
1234@};
1235
1236struct foo2
1237@{
1238 char x;
1239 int :0;
1240 char y;
1241@};
1242
1243main ()
1244@{
1245 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1246 sizeof (struct foo1));
1247 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1248 sizeof (struct foo2));
1249 exit (0);
1250@}
3ab51846 1251@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
1252
1253If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1254get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
a2c4f8e0 1255@end defmac
feca2ed3 1256
a2c4f8e0 1257@defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
f913c102
AO
1258Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1259to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
a2c4f8e0 1260@end defmac
feca2ed3 1261
b5bde9ff 1262@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD (void)
13c1cd82
PB
1263When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1264whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1265structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1266the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1267@end deftypefn
1268
b5bde9ff 1269@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD (void)
c2a64439
PB
1270This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1271should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1272these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1273
7d0b9a9c 1274The default is @code{false}.
c2a64439
PB
1275@end deftypefn
1276
ef4bddc2 1277@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (const_tree @var{field}, machine_mode @var{mode})
d9886a9e
L
1278Return true if a structure, union or array containing @var{field} should
1279be accessed using @code{BLKMODE}.
9f6dc500 1280
182e515e
AH
1281If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1282mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1283case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1284retain the field's mode.
1285
8d8da227 1286Normally, this is not needed.
d9886a9e 1287@end deftypefn
9f6dc500 1288
a2c4f8e0 1289@defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
0003feb2
VM
1290Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1291by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1292way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
feca2ed3
JW
1293@var{specified}.
1294
1295The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1296the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
a2c4f8e0 1297@end defmac
feca2ed3 1298
a2c4f8e0 1299@defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1300An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1301machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1302this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1303appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1304(DImode)} is assumed.
a2c4f8e0 1305@end defmac
feca2ed3 1306
a2c4f8e0 1307@defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
ef4bddc2 1308If defined, an expression of type @code{machine_mode} that
39403d82
DE
1309specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1310@code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1311@var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1312@code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1313having its mode specified.
73c8090f
DE
1314
1315You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1316would most commonly define this macro if the
1317@code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
131864-bit mode.
a2c4f8e0 1319@end defmac
73c8090f 1320
a2c4f8e0 1321@defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
ef4bddc2 1322If defined, an expression of type @code{machine_mode} that
39403d82
DE
1323specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1324@code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1325
1326You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1327You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1328pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
a2c4f8e0 1329@end defmac
39403d82 1330
ef4bddc2 1331@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE (void)
c7ff6e7a
AK
1332This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1333of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1334@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1335targets.
1336@end deftypefn
1337
ef4bddc2 1338@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE (void)
c7ff6e7a
AK
1339This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1340of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1341@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1342targets.
1343@end deftypefn
1344
ef4bddc2 1345@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE (void)
8a9a2486
JR
1346Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1347The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1348@end deftypefn
1349
9ddb66ef 1350@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P (const_tree @var{record_type})
f913c102
AO
1351This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1352@var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1353Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1354unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1355different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1356alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1357bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1358the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1359(iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
6335b0aa 1360another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
f913c102 1361other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
e4850f36
DR
1362
1363When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1364of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1365bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1366and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
8a36672b
JM
1367chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1368size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
e4850f36
DR
1369alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1370
1371If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
8a36672b 1372the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
e4850f36
DR
1373used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1374precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1375may affect its placement.
f913c102
AO
1376@end deftypefn
1377
9ddb66ef 1378@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
9a8ce21f 1379Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
9a8ce21f
JG
1380@end deftypefn
1381
9ddb66ef 1382@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
ab22c1fa
CF
1383Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1384@end deftypefn
1385
e41b2a33
PB
1386@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK (void)
1387This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1388to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1389For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1390for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1391registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1392usage.
1393@end deftypefn
1394
1395@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS (void)
1396This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1397that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1398@end deftypefn
1399
9ddb66ef 1400@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
608063c3
JB
1401If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1402uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1403to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1404mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1405the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1406not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1407for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1408return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1409string constant.
f18eca82
ZL
1410
1411Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1412qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1413fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1414is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1415length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1416ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1417@var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1418@var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1419code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1420@code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1421codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1422spaces in your string.
1423
608063c3
JB
1424This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1425name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1426can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1427before mangling.
1428
f18eca82
ZL
1429The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1430appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1431types.
1432@end deftypefn
1433
feca2ed3
JW
1434@node Type Layout
1435@section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1436
1437These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1438basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1439the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1440languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1441
a2c4f8e0 1442@defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1443A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1444target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
a2c4f8e0 1445@end defmac
feca2ed3 1446
a2c4f8e0 1447@defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1448A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1449target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1450(If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1451unit.)
a2c4f8e0 1452@end defmac
feca2ed3 1453
a2c4f8e0 1454@defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1455A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1456target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
a2c4f8e0 1457@end defmac
feca2ed3 1458
a2c4f8e0 1459@defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1615c261 1460On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
8a36672b 1461@code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1615c261
RK
1462that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1463the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1464value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
a2c4f8e0 1465@end defmac
1615c261 1466
a2c4f8e0 1467@defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1468A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1469target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
047c1c92 1470words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
feca2ed3 1471macro must be at least 64.
a2c4f8e0 1472@end defmac
feca2ed3 1473
a2c4f8e0 1474@defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3 1475A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
c294bd99
HPN
1476target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1477@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
a2c4f8e0 1478@end defmac
feca2ed3 1479
a2c4f8e0 1480@defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
3d1ad9e5
JM
1481A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1482C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1483this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
a2c4f8e0 1484@end defmac
68eb4fb9 1485
a2c4f8e0 1486@defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1487A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1488target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
a2c4f8e0 1489@end defmac
feca2ed3 1490
a2c4f8e0 1491@defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1492A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1493target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1494words.
a2c4f8e0 1495@end defmac
feca2ed3 1496
a2c4f8e0 1497@defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1498A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1499the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1500words.
a2c4f8e0 1501@end defmac
feca2ed3 1502
325217ed
CF
1503@defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1504A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1505the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1506@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1507@end defmac
1508
1509@defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1510A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1511the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1512@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1513@end defmac
1514
1515@defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1516A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1517the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1518@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1519@end defmac
1520
1521@defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1522A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1523the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1524@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1525@end defmac
1526
1527@defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1528A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1529the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1530@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1531@end defmac
1532
1533@defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1534A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1535the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1536@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1537@end defmac
1538
1539@defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1540A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1541the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1542@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1543@end defmac
1544
1545@defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1546A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1547the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1548@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1549@end defmac
1550
cdbf4541
BS
1551@defmac LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX
1552This macro corresponds to the @code{TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX} target
1553hook and should be defined if that hook is overriden to be true. It
1554causes function names in libgcc to be changed to use a @code{__gnu_}
1555prefix for their name rather than the default @code{__}. A port which
1556uses this macro should also arrange to use @file{t-gnu-prefix} in
1557the libgcc @file{config.host}.
1558@end defmac
1559
a2c4f8e0 1560@defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
d57a4b98
RH
1561A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1562assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1563default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1564@code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
a2c4f8e0 1565@end defmac
aaa2e8ef 1566
a2c4f8e0 1567@defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
e9a25f70
JL
1568A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1569supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1570value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1571If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1572is the default.
a2c4f8e0 1573@end defmac
e9a25f70 1574
a2c4f8e0 1575@defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
feca2ed3
JW
1576An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1577@code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
630d3d5a
JM
1578always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1579and @option{-funsigned-char}.
a2c4f8e0 1580@end defmac
feca2ed3 1581
221ee7c9
KH
1582@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS (void)
1583This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1584@code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1585of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
35afa569
KH
1586@code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1587
221ee7c9
KH
1588The default is to return false.
1589@end deftypefn
35afa569 1590
a2c4f8e0 1591@defmac SIZE_TYPE
feca2ed3
JW
1592A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1593for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1594contents of the string.
1595
1596The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1597spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1598appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1599of the data type names defined in the function
176a96de
HPN
1600@code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins} in the file @file{c-family/c-common.c}.
1601You may not omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the
1602compiler to crash on startup.
feca2ed3
JW
1603
1604If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1605int"}.
a2c4f8e0 1606@end defmac
feca2ed3 1607
18dae016
TG
1608@defmac SIZETYPE
1609GCC defines internal types (@code{sizetype}, @code{ssizetype},
1610@code{bitsizetype} and @code{sbitsizetype}) for expressions
1611dealing with size. This macro is a C expression for a string describing
1612the name of the data type from which the precision of @code{sizetype}
1613is extracted.
1614
1615The string has the same restrictions as @code{SIZE_TYPE} string.
1616
1617If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{SIZE_TYPE}.
1618@end defmac
1619
a2c4f8e0 1620@defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
feca2ed3
JW
1621A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1622for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1623@code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1624@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1625
1626If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
a2c4f8e0 1627@end defmac
feca2ed3 1628
a2c4f8e0 1629@defmac WCHAR_TYPE
feca2ed3
JW
1630A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1631for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1632the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1633information.
1634
1635If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
a2c4f8e0 1636@end defmac
feca2ed3 1637
a2c4f8e0 1638@defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1639A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1640characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1641@code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
a2c4f8e0 1642@end defmac
feca2ed3 1643
a2c4f8e0 1644@defmac WINT_TYPE
1a67c7d3
JL
1645A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1646use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1647@code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1648contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1649information.
1650
1651If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
a2c4f8e0 1652@end defmac
1a67c7d3 1653
a2c4f8e0 1654@defmac INTMAX_TYPE
b15ad712
JM
1655A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1656can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1657The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1658string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1659
1660If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1661@code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1662much precision as @code{long long int}.
a2c4f8e0 1663@end defmac
b15ad712 1664
a2c4f8e0 1665@defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
b15ad712
JM
1666A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1667can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1668type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1669of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1670
1671If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1672@code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1673unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1674int}.
a2c4f8e0 1675@end defmac
b15ad712 1676
207bf79d
JM
1677@defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1678@defmacx INT8_TYPE
1679@defmacx INT16_TYPE
1680@defmacx INT32_TYPE
1681@defmacx INT64_TYPE
1682@defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1683@defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1684@defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1685@defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1686@defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1687@defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1688@defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1689@defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1690@defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1691@defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1692@defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1693@defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1694@defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1695@defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1696@defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1697@defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1698@defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1699@defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1700@defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1701@defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1702@defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1703@defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1704C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1705@code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1706@code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1707@code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1708@code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1709@code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1710@code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1711@code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1712@code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1713@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1714
1715If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1716type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1717@code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1718to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1719these macros are null pointers.
1720@end defmac
1721
a2c4f8e0 1722@defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
f3c55c97
AO
1723The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1724that looks like:
1725
3ab51846 1726@smallexample
f3c55c97
AO
1727 struct @{
1728 union @{
1729 void (*fn)();
1730 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1731 @};
1732 ptrdiff_t delta;
1733 @};
3ab51846 1734@end smallexample
f3c55c97
AO
1735
1736@noindent
1737The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1738will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1739Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1740always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1741distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1742platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1743that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1744the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1745
1746GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1747this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1748However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1749set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1750bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1751address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1752architecture, you should define this macro to
1753@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1754
1755In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1756in which function addresses are always even, according to
1757@code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1758@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
a2c4f8e0 1759@end defmac
67231816 1760
a2c4f8e0 1761@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
67231816 1762Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
f282ffb3 1763macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
67231816
RH
1764instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1765function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
f282ffb3 1766data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
67231816
RH
1767pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1768
1769If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1770of words that the function descriptor occupies.
a2c4f8e0 1771@end defmac
a6f5e048 1772
a2c4f8e0 1773@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
a6f5e048
RH
1774By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1775is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1776the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1777when special alignment is necessary. */
a2c4f8e0 1778@end defmac
a6f5e048 1779
a2c4f8e0 1780@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
a6f5e048
RH
1781There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1782zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1783specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1784of words in each data entry.
a2c4f8e0 1785@end defmac
b2b263e1 1786
feca2ed3
JW
1787@node Registers
1788@section Register Usage
1789@cindex register usage
1790
1791This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1792has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1793
1794The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1795done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1796on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1797For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1798For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1799
1800@menu
6ccde948
RW
1801* Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1802* Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1803* Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1804* Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1805* Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
feca2ed3
JW
1806@end menu
1807
1808@node Register Basics
1809@subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1810
1811@c prevent bad page break with this line
1812Registers have various characteristics.
1813
a2c4f8e0 1814@defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
feca2ed3
JW
1815Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1816numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1817pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1818@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
a2c4f8e0 1819@end defmac
feca2ed3 1820
a2c4f8e0 1821@defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
feca2ed3
JW
1822@cindex fixed register
1823An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1824all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1825general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1826pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1827register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1828machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1829and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1830
1831This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1832commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1833register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1834
1835The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1836the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1837by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
630d3d5a
JM
1838the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1839@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
a2c4f8e0 1840@end defmac
feca2ed3 1841
a2c4f8e0 1842@defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
feca2ed3
JW
1843@cindex call-used register
1844@cindex call-clobbered register
1845@cindex call-saved register
1846Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1847clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1848registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1849available for general allocation of values that must live across
1850function calls.
1851
1852If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1853automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1854exit, if the register is used within the function.
a2c4f8e0 1855@end defmac
feca2ed3 1856
a2c4f8e0 1857@defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
fc1296b7
AM
1858@cindex call-used register
1859@cindex call-clobbered register
1860@cindex call-saved register
f282ffb3
JM
1861Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1862that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
fc1296b7 1863(@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
f282ffb3 1864This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
fc1296b7 1865of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
a2c4f8e0 1866@end defmac
fc1296b7 1867
a2c4f8e0 1868@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1e326708
MH
1869@cindex call-used register
1870@cindex call-clobbered register
1871@cindex call-saved register
df2a54e9 1872A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1e326708
MH
1873value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1874call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1875macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1876preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
a2c4f8e0 1877@end defmac
1e326708 1878
feca2ed3
JW
1879@findex fixed_regs
1880@findex call_used_regs
a2c4f8e0
ZW
1881@findex global_regs
1882@findex reg_names
1883@findex reg_class_contents
5efd84c5
NF
1884@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE (void)
1885This hook may conditionally modify five variables
055177dc 1886@code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
c237e94a
ZW
1887@code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1888any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1889of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1890@code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1891@code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1892called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1893@code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
055177dc 1894from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
c237e94a 1895@code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
630d3d5a 1896@code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
c237e94a
ZW
1897@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1898command options have been applied.
feca2ed3 1899
feca2ed3
JW
1900@cindex disabling certain registers
1901@cindex controlling register usage
1902If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1903flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1904@code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
b48e9677
RS
1905registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also make
1906@code{define_register_constraint}s return @code{NO_REGS} for constraints
1907that shouldn't be used.
feca2ed3
JW
1908
1909(However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1910of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1911controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1912these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
5efd84c5 1913@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 1914
a2c4f8e0 1915@defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
feca2ed3
JW
1916Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1917expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1918corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1919function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1920outbound register.
a2c4f8e0 1921@end defmac
feca2ed3 1922
a2c4f8e0 1923@defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
feca2ed3
JW
1924Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1925expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1926corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1927function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1928register.
a2c4f8e0 1929@end defmac
feca2ed3 1930
a2c4f8e0 1931@defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
fa80e43d
JL
1932Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1933expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1934register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1935need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1936gotos.
a2c4f8e0 1937@end defmac
fa80e43d 1938
a2c4f8e0 1939@defmac PC_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
1940If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1941register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
a2c4f8e0 1942@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
1943
1944@node Allocation Order
1945@subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1946@cindex order of register allocation
1947@cindex register allocation order
1948
1949@c prevent bad page break with this line
1950Registers are allocated in order.
1951
a2c4f8e0 1952@defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
feca2ed3 1953If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
a3a15b4d 1954numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
feca2ed3
JW
1955to use them (from most preferred to least).
1956
1957If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1958(all else being equal).
1959
1960One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1961registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1962instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
1963machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
956d6950 1964the highest numbered allocable register first.
a2c4f8e0 1965@end defmac
feca2ed3 1966
5a733826 1967@defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
feca2ed3
JW
1968A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
1969hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
1970
1971Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
1972Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
1973register; and so on.
1974
1975The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
1976@code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
1977
1978On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
a2c4f8e0 1979@end defmac
feca2ed3 1980
5a733826
BS
1981@defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1982Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
1983prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
1984using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
1985allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
ed15c598
KC
1986call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, then define this
1987macro as a C expression to nonzero. Default is 0.
5a733826
BS
1988@end defmac
1989
058e97ec
VM
1990@defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
1991In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
1992Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
1993If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
1994based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
1995be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
1996value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
1997to having it always return @code{0.0}.
1998
1999On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2000@end defmac
2001
feca2ed3
JW
2002@node Values in Registers
2003@subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2004
2005This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2006(specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2007consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2008
a2c4f8e0 2009@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
feca2ed3
JW
2010A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2011at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
79e168da
DD
2012@var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2013cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2014and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
feca2ed3
JW
2015
2016On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2017definition of this macro is
2018
2019@smallexample
2020#define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2021 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
32bd3974 2022 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
feca2ed3 2023@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 2024@end defmac
feca2ed3 2025
8521c414
JM
2026@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2027A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2028in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2029in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2030multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2031this mode by the number of registers returned by
2032@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2033
2034For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2035registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2036nonzero.
2037
2038This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
f1f4e530 2039@code{subreg_get_info}
8521c414
JM
2040would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2041represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2042@code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2043registers and so not be representable.
2044@end defmac
2045
2046@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2047For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2048@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2049returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2050including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2051@end defmac
2052
ca0b6e3b
EB
2053@defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2054Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2055of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2056should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2057used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2058happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2059floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2060@end defmac
2061
a2c4f8e0 2062@defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
feca2ed3
JW
2063A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2064of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2065registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2066are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2067
2068@smallexample
2069#define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2070@end smallexample
2071
e9a25f70
JL
2072You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2073because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
feca2ed3
JW
2074
2075@cindex register pairs
2076On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
e9a25f70
JL
2077register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2078odd register numbers for such modes.
feca2ed3
JW
2079
2080The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2081@samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
e9a25f70
JL
2082register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2083value into the register and back out not alter it.
feca2ed3 2084
e9a25f70
JL
2085Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2086all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
feca2ed3
JW
2087@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2088you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2089is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2090and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2091to be tieable.
2092
2093Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2094Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2095in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2096can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2097mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2098registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2099
2100On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2101modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2102registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2103non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2104@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2105floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2106normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2107unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2108register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2109
2110The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2111they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2112instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2113@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2114constraints for those instructions.
2115
2116On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2117so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2118register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2119floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2120be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
a2c4f8e0 2121@end defmac
feca2ed3 2122
150c9fe8
KH
2123@defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2124A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2125@var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2126
2127One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2128another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2129handler.
2130
2131The default is always nonzero.
2132@end defmac
2133
a2c4f8e0 2134@defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
e9a25f70 2135A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
956d6950 2136@var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
feca2ed3
JW
2137
2138If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
e9a25f70
JL
2139@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2140any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2141should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2142this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
956d6950 2143accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
e9a25f70
JL
2144
2145You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
a3a15b4d 2146possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
e9a25f70 2147allocation.
a2c4f8e0 2148@end defmac
7506f491 2149
dbc42c44
AS
2150@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK (unsigned int @var{regno})
2151This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2152@var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2153
2154One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2155is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2156
2157The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2158@end deftypefn
2159
a2c4f8e0 2160@defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
7506f491 2161Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
a89608cb 2162registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
7506f491 2163@code{CCmode} is incomplete.
a2c4f8e0 2164@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
2165
2166@node Leaf Functions
2167@subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2168
2169@cindex leaf functions
2170@cindex functions, leaf
2171On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2172more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2173means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2174are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2175normally arrive.
2176
2177The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2178other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2179registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2180function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2181handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2182functions''.
2183
a3a15b4d 2184GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
feca2ed3
JW
2185suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2186registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2187accomplish this.
2188
a2c4f8e0 2189@defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
7d167afd 2190Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
feca2ed3
JW
2191contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2192function treatment.
2193
2194If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2195registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
a3a15b4d 2196GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
feca2ed3
JW
2197used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2198in this vector.
2199
2200Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2201the treatment of leaf functions.
a2c4f8e0 2202@end defmac
feca2ed3 2203
a2c4f8e0 2204@defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
feca2ed3
JW
2205A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2206should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2207
2208If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
630d3d5a 2209function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
feca2ed3
JW
2210will cause the compiler to abort.
2211
2212Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2213treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2214this.
a2c4f8e0 2215@end defmac
feca2ed3 2216
54ff41b7
JW
2217@findex current_function_is_leaf
2218@findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
c237e94a
ZW
2219@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2220@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2221specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2222which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2223set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
08c148a8
NB
2224compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2225@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2226functions which only use leaf registers.
9ac617d4
EB
2227@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2228that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2229@code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
feca2ed3
JW
2230@c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2231@c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2232
2233@node Stack Registers
2234@subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2235
2236There are special features to handle computers where some of the
a2c4f8e0
ZW
2237``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2238pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2239stack.
feca2ed3 2240
a3a15b4d 2241Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
a2c4f8e0
ZW
2242they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2243support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2244point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2245stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2246@file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2247with it, as well as defining these macros.
2248
2249@defmac STACK_REGS
feca2ed3 2250Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
a2c4f8e0 2251@end defmac
feca2ed3 2252
1833192f
VM
2253@defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2254This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2255the machine has any stack-like registers.
2256@end defmac
2257
a2c4f8e0 2258@defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
feca2ed3
JW
2259The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2260of the stack.
a2c4f8e0 2261@end defmac
feca2ed3 2262
a2c4f8e0 2263@defmac LAST_STACK_REG
feca2ed3
JW
2264The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2265the stack.
a2c4f8e0 2266@end defmac
feca2ed3 2267
feca2ed3
JW
2268@node Register Classes
2269@section Register Classes
2270@cindex register class definitions
2271@cindex class definitions, register
2272
2273On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2274For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2275certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2276restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2277
2278You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2279which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2280that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2281
2282@findex ALL_REGS
2283@findex NO_REGS
2284In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2285class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2286class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2287union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2288
2289@findex GENERAL_REGS
2290One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2291terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2292@samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2293the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2294to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2295
2296Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2297then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2298
2299The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2300constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2301You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2302them in operand constraints.
2303
6049a4c8
HPN
2304You must define the narrowest register classes for allocatable
2305registers, so that each class either has no subclasses, or that for
2306some mode, the move cost between registers within the class is
2307cheaper than moving a register in the class to or from memory
2308(@pxref{Costs}).
2309
feca2ed3
JW
2310You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2311instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2312either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2313certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
b899fd78
JR
2314which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code,
2315or even internal compiler errors when reload cannot find a register in the
dd5a833e 2316class computed via @code{reg_class_subunion}.
feca2ed3
JW
2317
2318You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2319classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2320contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2321in their union.
2322
2323When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2324certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2325Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2326a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2327specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2328
2329Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2330instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2331each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2332mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2333single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2334this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2335instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2336single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2337@code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2338
a2c4f8e0 2339@deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2eac577f
JM
2340An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2341as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2342must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
feca2ed3
JW
2343@code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2344tells how many classes there are.
2345
2346Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2347the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2348in many of the tables described below.
a2c4f8e0 2349@end deftp
feca2ed3 2350
a2c4f8e0 2351@defmac N_REG_CLASSES
feca2ed3
JW
2352The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2353
3ab51846 2354@smallexample
feca2ed3 2355#define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
3ab51846 2356@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 2357@end defmac
feca2ed3 2358
a2c4f8e0 2359@defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
feca2ed3
JW
2360An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2361constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
a2c4f8e0 2362@end defmac
feca2ed3 2363
a2c4f8e0 2364@defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
feca2ed3
JW
2365An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2366which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2367@var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2368register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2369
2370When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2371Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2372several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2373for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
7c272079
MP
2374In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2375registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2376so on.
a2c4f8e0 2377@end defmac
feca2ed3 2378
a2c4f8e0 2379@defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
feca2ed3
JW
2380A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2381@var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2382which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2383register.
a2c4f8e0 2384@end defmac
feca2ed3 2385
a2c4f8e0 2386@defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
feca2ed3
JW
2387A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2388base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2389which is the register value plus a displacement.
a2c4f8e0 2390@end defmac
feca2ed3 2391
a2c4f8e0 2392@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
3dcc68a4 2393This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
c0478a66 2394the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
3dcc68a4
NC
2395@var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2396@code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
a2c4f8e0 2397@end defmac
3dcc68a4 2398
888d2cd6
DJ
2399@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2400A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2401base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2402register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2403addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2404@end defmac
2405
86fc3d06 2406@defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
c4963a0a 2407A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
86fc3d06
UW
2408base register for a memory reference in mode @var{mode} to address
2409space @var{address_space} must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code}
2410define the context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is
2411the code of the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level
2412of an address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
c4963a0a
BS
2413@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2414index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2415@end defmac
2416
a2c4f8e0 2417@defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
feca2ed3
JW
2418A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2419index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2420address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2421added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
a2c4f8e0 2422@end defmac
feca2ed3 2423
a2c4f8e0 2424@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
feca2ed3 2425A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
1c62e8f2 2426suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
a2c4f8e0 2427@end defmac
feca2ed3 2428
a2c4f8e0 2429@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
861bb6c1
JL
2430A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2431that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2432@var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2433reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2434you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
ab873839
RW
2435@code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2436addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2437@code{address_operand}.
a2c4f8e0 2438@end defmac
861bb6c1 2439
888d2cd6
DJ
2440@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2441A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2442use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2443memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2444pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2445define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2446than other base register uses.
c4963a0a
BS
2447
2448Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2449@code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2450@end defmac
2451
86fc3d06
UW
2452@defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2453A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2454suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses, accessing
2455memory in mode @var{mode} in address space @var{address_space}.
2456This is similar to @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
ab873839
RW
2457that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2458appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2459immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2460address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2461@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2462corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
c4963a0a 2463@code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
ab873839 2464that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
888d2cd6
DJ
2465@end defmac
2466
a2c4f8e0 2467@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
feca2ed3
JW
2468A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2469suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2470either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2471allocated such a hard register.
2472
2473The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2474the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2475two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2476labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2477labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2478may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2479looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2480only if neither labeling works.
a2c4f8e0 2481@end defmac
feca2ed3 2482
5f286f4a 2483@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RENAME_CLASS (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
6d3fbe2f 2484A target hook that places additional preference on the register class to use when it is necessary to rename a register in class @var{rclass} to another class, or perhaps @var{NO_REGS}, if no preferred register class is found or hook @code{preferred_rename_class} is not implemented. Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For example, on ARM, thumb-2 instructions using @code{LO_REGS} may be smaller than instructions using @code{GENERIC_REGS}. By returning @code{LO_REGS} from @code{preferred_rename_class}, code size can be reduced.
5f286f4a
YQ
2485@end deftypefn
2486
fba42e24
AS
2487@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2488A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2489to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2490@var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2491another, smaller class.
2492
2493The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2494
2495Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2496example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2497for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2498@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2499Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2500
2501One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2502@var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2503loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2504force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2505immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2506instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2507register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2508@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2509into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
1a627b35 2510@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
fba42e24
AS
2511of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2512
2513If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2514through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2515to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2516reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2517this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2518the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2519@end deftypefn
2520
a2c4f8e0 2521@defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
feca2ed3
JW
2522A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2523to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2524@var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2525another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2526safe:
2527
3ab51846 2528@smallexample
feca2ed3 2529#define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
3ab51846 2530@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
2531
2532Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2533example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2534for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2535@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2536Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2537
222a2f1a
GK
2538One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2539@var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2540loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2541force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2542immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2543instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2544register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2545@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2546into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
1a627b35
RS
2547@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2548of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
b5c82fa1
PB
2549
2550If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2551through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2552to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2553reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2554this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2555the SSE registers (and vice versa).
a2c4f8e0 2556@end defmac
feca2ed3 2557
abd26bfb
AS
2558@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2559Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2560input reloads.
2561
2562The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2563argument.
2564
2565You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2566reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2567@end deftypefn
2568
a2c4f8e0 2569@defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
feca2ed3
JW
2570A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2571to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2572@var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2573ordinarily be used.
2574
2575Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2576there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2577
2578The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2579smaller class.
2580
2581Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2582require the macro to do something nontrivial.
a2c4f8e0 2583@end defmac
feca2ed3 2584
ef4bddc2 2585@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD (bool @var{in_p}, rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{reload_class}, machine_mode @var{reload_mode}, secondary_reload_info *@var{sri})
feca2ed3
JW
2586Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2587from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2588@samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
8a99f6f9
R
2589from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2590term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2591directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2592register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2593destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2594source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2595reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2596and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2597intermediate register still holds the required value.
2598
2599Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2600allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2601register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2602address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2603when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
e4ae5e77 2604as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
8a99f6f9
R
2605that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2606describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2607these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2608of the scratch register(s).
2609
2610In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2611
2612For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
9bdf23b2 2613and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
8a99f6f9 2614@var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
9bdf23b2 2615hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
8a99f6f9
R
2616needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2617
2618If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2619an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2620return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2621If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2622If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2623that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2624
2625If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2626perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2627closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2628required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2629copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2630
2631You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2632in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2633and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2634for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2635single-register-class
2636@c [later: or memory]
2637output constraint.
2638
2639When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2640hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2641register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2642have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2643
2644@c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2645@c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2646@c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2647@c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2648@c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2649@c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2650@c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2651@c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2652
2653
2654@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2655pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2656Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2657in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2658
2659Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2660currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2661to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2662
2663@code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2664copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2665(a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2666Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2667of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2668forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2669@end deftypefn
2670
2671@defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2672@defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2673@defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
083cad55 2674These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
8a99f6f9
R
2675@code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2676
2677These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2678target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2679reload phase that it may
feca2ed3
JW
2680need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2681register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2682register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
8a99f6f9 2683you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
feca2ed3
JW
2684largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2685intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2686
2687If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2688intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
8a99f6f9
R
2689was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2690class required. If the
2691requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2692@code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
feca2ed3
JW
2693macros identically.
2694
2695The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2696Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2697can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2698@var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2699macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2700
2701If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
8a99f6f9 2702intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
feca2ed3 2703@samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
8a99f6f9 2704(@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
feca2ed3
JW
2705implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2706@samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2707register.
2708
8a99f6f9
R
2709These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2710register that
feca2ed3
JW
2711contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2712class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2713value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2714register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2715Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2716
2717@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2718pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
630d3d5a 2719Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
feca2ed3
JW
2720in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2721
2722These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2723registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2724registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2725would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
a8154559 2726the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
feca2ed3
JW
2727intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2728general registers.
a2c4f8e0 2729@end defmac
feca2ed3 2730
a2c4f8e0 2731@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
feca2ed3
JW
2732Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2733to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
df2a54e9 2734those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
feca2ed3
JW
2735@var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2736class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2737and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2738
2739Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
a2c4f8e0 2740@end defmac
feca2ed3 2741
a2c4f8e0 2742@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
feca2ed3
JW
2743Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2744allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2745If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2746defined by this macro.
2747
2748Do not define this macro if you do not define
2749@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
a2c4f8e0 2750@end defmac
feca2ed3 2751
a2c4f8e0 2752@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
feca2ed3
JW
2753When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2754registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2755hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2756load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2757same as that of @var{mode}.
2758
2759This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2760bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2761in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2762registers.
2763
2764However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2765the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2766differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2767widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2768suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2769details.
2770
2771Do not define this macro if you do not define
2772@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2773is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
a2c4f8e0 2774@end defmac
feca2ed3 2775
07b8f0a8
AS
2776@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2777A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2778to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2779registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2780
2781The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2782has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
aeb9f7cf
SB
2783default should be used. For generally register-starved machines, such as
2784i386, or machines with right register constraints, such as SH, this hook
2785can be used to avoid excessive spilling.
2786
2787This hook is also used by some of the global intra-procedural code
2788transformations to throtle code motion, to avoid increasing register
2789pressure.
07b8f0a8
AS
2790@end deftypefn
2791
ef4bddc2 2792@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (reg_class_t @var{rclass}, machine_mode @var{mode})
a8c44c52
AS
2793A target hook returns the maximum number of consecutive registers
2794of class @var{rclass} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2795
2796This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
1c7836f0 2797the value returned by @code{TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{rclass},
a8c44c52
AS
2798@var{mode})} target hook should be the maximum value of
2799@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})} for all @var{regno}
2800values in the class @var{rclass}.
2801
2802This target hook helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2803in the reload pass.
2804
2805The default version of this target hook returns the size of @var{mode}
2806in words.
2807@end deftypefn
2808
a2c4f8e0 2809@defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
feca2ed3
JW
2810A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2811of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2812
2813This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2814the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2815should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2816@var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2817
2818This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2819in the reload pass.
a2c4f8e0 2820@end defmac
feca2ed3 2821
a2c4f8e0 2822@defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
b0c42aed
JH
2823If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2824a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
feca2ed3
JW
2825
2826For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
57694e40 2827floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
feca2ed3 2828Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
57694e40 2829does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
cff9f8d5
AH
2830register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2831as below:
02188693 2832
3ab51846 2833@smallexample
b0c42aed
JH
2834#define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2835 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2836 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
3ab51846 2837@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 2838@end defmac
feca2ed3 2839
5074a1f8
VM
2840@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_IRA_CHANGE_PSEUDO_ALLOCNO_CLASS (int, @var{reg_class_t})
2841A target hook which can change allocno class for given pseudo from
2842 allocno class calculated by IRA.
2843
2844 The default version of this target hook always returns given class.
2845@end deftypefn
2846
55a2c322
VM
2847@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LRA_P (void)
2848A target hook which returns true if we use LRA instead of reload pass. It means that LRA was ported to the target. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2849@end deftypefn
2850
2851@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_PRIORITY (int)
2852A target hook which returns the register priority number to which the register @var{hard_regno} belongs to. The bigger the number, the more preferable the hard register usage (when all other conditions are the same). This hook can be used to prefer some hard register over others in LRA. For example, some x86-64 register usage needs additional prefix which makes instructions longer. The hook can return lower priority number for such registers make them less favorable and as result making the generated code smaller. The default version of this target hook returns always zero.
2853@end deftypefn
2854
3b9ceb4b
VM
2855@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REGISTER_USAGE_LEVELING_P (void)
2856A target hook which returns true if we need register usage leveling. That means if a few hard registers are equally good for the assignment, we choose the least used hard register. The register usage leveling may be profitable for some targets. Don't use the usage leveling for targets with conditional execution or targets with big register files as it hurts if-conversion and cross-jumping optimizations. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2857@end deftypefn
2858
55a2c322
VM
2859@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DIFFERENT_ADDR_DISPLACEMENT_P (void)
2860A target hook which returns true if an address with the same structure can have different maximal legitimate displacement. For example, the displacement can depend on memory mode or on operand combinations in the insn. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2861@end deftypefn
2862
d6220b11
KK
2863@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_SUBSTITUTE_MEM_EQUIV_P (rtx @var{subst})
2864A target hook which returns @code{true} if @var{subst} can't
2865substitute safely pseudos with equivalent memory values during
2866register allocation.
2867The default version of this target hook returns @code{false}.
2868On most machines, this default should be used. For generally
2869machines with non orthogonal register usage for addressing, such
2870as SH, this hook can be used to avoid excessive spilling.
2871@end deftypefn
2872
14133a4d
KK
2873@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS_DISPLACEMENT (rtx *@var{disp}, rtx *@var{offset}, machine_mode @var{mode})
2874A target hook which returns @code{true} if *@var{disp} is
2875legitimezed to valid address displacement with subtracting *@var{offset}
2876at memory mode @var{mode}.
2877The default version of this target hook returns @code{false}.
2878This hook will benefit machines with limited base plus displacement
2879addressing.
2880@end deftypefn
2881
ef4bddc2 2882@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SPILL_CLASS (reg_class_t, @var{machine_mode})
55a2c322
VM
2883This hook defines a class of registers which could be used for spilling pseudos of the given mode and class, or @code{NO_REGS} if only memory should be used. Not defining this hook is equivalent to returning @code{NO_REGS} for all inputs.
2884@end deftypefn
2885
ef4bddc2 2886@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_CSTORE_MODE (enum insn_code @var{icode})
42e37616
DM
2887This hook defines the machine mode to use for the boolean result of conditional store patterns. The ICODE argument is the instruction code for the cstore being performed. Not definiting this hook is the same as accepting the mode encoded into operand 0 of the cstore expander patterns.
2888@end deftypefn
2889
feca2ed3
JW
2890@node Stack and Calling
2891@section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
2892@cindex calling conventions
2893
2894@c prevent bad page break with this line
2895This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
2896
2897@menu
2898* Frame Layout::
7c16328b 2899* Exception Handling::
861bb6c1 2900* Stack Checking::
feca2ed3
JW
2901* Frame Registers::
2902* Elimination::
2903* Stack Arguments::
2904* Register Arguments::
2905* Scalar Return::
2906* Aggregate Return::
2907* Caller Saves::
2908* Function Entry::
2909* Profiling::
91d231cb 2910* Tail Calls::
7d69de61 2911* Stack Smashing Protection::
aaeaa9a9 2912* Miscellaneous Register Hooks::
feca2ed3
JW
2913@end menu
2914
2915@node Frame Layout
2916@subsection Basic Stack Layout
2917@cindex stack frame layout
2918@cindex frame layout
2919
2920@c prevent bad page break with this line
2921Here is the basic stack layout.
2922
a2c4f8e0 2923@defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
62f9f30b
TS
2924Define this macro to be true if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
2925pointer to a smaller address, and false otherwise.
a2c4f8e0 2926@end defmac
feca2ed3 2927
a2c4f8e0 2928@defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
918a6124
GK
2929This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
2930on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
04a5176a 2931@code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
918a6124
GK
2932
2933The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
2934and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
2935the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
2936to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
2937space for the next item on the stack.
2938
2939The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
62f9f30b 2940true, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
918a6124 2941which is often wrong.
a2c4f8e0 2942@end defmac
918a6124 2943
a2c4f8e0 2944@defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
a4d05547 2945Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
f62c8a5c 2946are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
a2c4f8e0 2947@end defmac
feca2ed3 2948
a2c4f8e0 2949@defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
feca2ed3
JW
2950Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
2951addresses on the stack.
a2c4f8e0 2952@end defmac
feca2ed3 2953
a2c4f8e0 2954@defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
feca2ed3
JW
2955Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
2956
2957If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
2958subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2959Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
2960value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2961@c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
2962@c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
a2c4f8e0 2963@end defmac
feca2ed3 2964
a2c4f8e0 2965@defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
95f3f59e 2966Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
0b4be7de 2967The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
95f3f59e 2968
0b4be7de 2969On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
95f3f59e
JDA
2970is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
2971alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
2972stack alignment and do it in the backend.
a2c4f8e0 2973@end defmac
95f3f59e 2974
a2c4f8e0 2975@defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
feca2ed3
JW
2976Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
2977outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
2978zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
2979
2980If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
2981the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
a2c4f8e0 2982@end defmac
feca2ed3 2983
a2c4f8e0 2984@defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
feca2ed3
JW
2985Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
2986address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
2987function.
2988
2989If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
2990the first argument's address.
a2c4f8e0 2991@end defmac
feca2ed3 2992
a2c4f8e0 2993@defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
feca2ed3
JW
2994Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
2995on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
2996
2997The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
2998length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
2999machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
a2c4f8e0 3000@end defmac
feca2ed3 3001
c6d01079
AK
3002@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3003A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
083cad55 3004stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
c8f27794
JW
3005@code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3006default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
083cad55 3007elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
c8f27794 3008@code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
c6d01079
AK
3009@end defmac
3010
a2c4f8e0 3011@defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
feca2ed3
JW
3012A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3013frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3014@var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3015itself.
3016
3017If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3018of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3019address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
a2c4f8e0 3020@end defmac
feca2ed3 3021
a2c4f8e0 3022@defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
feca2ed3
JW
3023If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3024setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
981f6289 3025on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
0bc02db4
MS
3026before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3027define this macro.
a2c4f8e0 3028@end defmac
0bc02db4 3029
9ddb66ef 3030@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE (void)
d6da68b9 3031This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
0bc02db4
MS
3032the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3033The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
d6da68b9 3034machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
0bc02db4 3035@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
d6da68b9 3036@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 3037
224869d9
EB
3038@defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3039A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3040address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3041of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3042You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3043as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3044@end defmac
3045
a2c4f8e0 3046@defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
feca2ed3 3047A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
861bb6c1
JL
3048address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3049the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3050frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
a55bbe13 3051@code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is nonzero.
feca2ed3 3052
e9a25f70 3053The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
4830ba1f 3054@var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
e9a25f70 3055determine the return address of other frames.
a2c4f8e0 3056@end defmac
e9a25f70 3057
a2c4f8e0 3058@defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
a55bbe13
L
3059Define this macro to nonzero value if the return address of a particular
3060stack frame is accessed from the frame pointer of the previous stack
3061frame. The zero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
a2c4f8e0 3062@end defmac
861bb6c1 3063
a2c4f8e0 3064@defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
861bb6c1
JL
3065A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3066incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3067prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3068value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3069the stack.
3070
3071You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3072debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3073
2c849145 3074If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
aee96fe9 3075@code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
a2c4f8e0 3076@end defmac
2c849145 3077
ed80cd68 3078@defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
73774972 3079A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
5cd0f915
RS
3080number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3081must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3082be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3083
3084This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3085general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3086frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3087over time.
ed80cd68
RH
3088@end defmac
3089
282efe1c
RH
3090@defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3091A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3092number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3093only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3094someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3095terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3096@end defmac
3097
e54c7471
EB
3098@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC (const char *@var{label}, rtx @var{pattern}, int @var{index})
3099This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3100contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3101info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3102@smallexample
923158be 3103(set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
e54c7471
EB
3104@end smallexample
3105and
3106@smallexample
923158be 3107(set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
e54c7471
EB
3108@end smallexample
3109to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3110the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3111the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3112@end deftypefn
3113
a2c4f8e0 3114@defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
861bb6c1
JL
3115A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3116from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3117frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3118the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3119previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3120
71038426
RH
3121You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3122debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
a2c4f8e0 3123@end defmac
71038426 3124
a2c4f8e0 3125@defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
71038426
RH
3126A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3127from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
02f52e19 3128final value should coincide with that calculated by
71038426
RH
3129@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3130during virtual register instantiation.
3131
d17c29c3
PB
3132The default value for this macro is
3133@code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
2c849145 3134which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
208e52d9
JM
3135immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3136some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3137and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
2c849145 3138
208e52d9 3139You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
2c849145
JM
3140want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3141DWARF 2.
a2c4f8e0 3142@end defmac
512b62fb 3143
f6672e8e
RH
3144@defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3145If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3146in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
6fc0bb99 3147The final value should coincide with that calculated by
f6672e8e
RH
3148@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3149
3150Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
083cad55 3151via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
f6672e8e 3152variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
6416ae7f 3153defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
f6672e8e
RH
3154based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3155of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3156should be defined.
3157@end defmac
3158
35d177a2
AO
3159@defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3160If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3161in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3162in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3163may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3164@end defmac
3165
7c16328b
RH
3166@node Exception Handling
3167@subsection Exception Handling Support
3168@cindex exception handling
3169
a2c4f8e0 3170@defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
52a11cbf
RH
3171A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3172data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3173@var{N} registers are usable.
3174
3175The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3176handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3177should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3178but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
31792 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3180
3181You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3182handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
a2c4f8e0 3183@end defmac
52a11cbf 3184
a2c4f8e0 3185@defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
52a11cbf
RH
3186A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3187to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3188This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3189It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3190
02f52e19 3191Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
52a11cbf
RH
3192untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3193
34dc173c 3194Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
73774972
EC
3195by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3196this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3197stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3198this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
34dc173c 3199that provided by DWARF 2.
a2c4f8e0 3200@end defmac
52a11cbf 3201
a2c4f8e0 3202@defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
52a11cbf 3203A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
02f52e19 3204to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
52a11cbf
RH
3205return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3206
3207Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
02f52e19
AJ
3208return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3209address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
52a11cbf 3210the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
73774972
EC
3211frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3212been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
34dc173c 3213target call frame.
52a11cbf
RH
3214
3215Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3216address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3217the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3218
3219If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3220define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
a2c4f8e0 3221@end defmac
52a11cbf 3222
1e60c057
R
3223@defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3224If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3225to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3226exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3227using it to return to the exception handler.
3228@end defmac
3229
a2c4f8e0 3230@defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
2a1ee410
RH
3231This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3232handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3233that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3234and so may be read-only.
3235
aee96fe9
JM
3236@var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3237@var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
2a1ee410
RH
3238The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3239as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3240
ebb48a4d 3241If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
2a1ee410 3242represented directly.
a2c4f8e0 3243@end defmac
2a1ee410 3244
a2c4f8e0 3245@defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
2a1ee410
RH
3246This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3247to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3248Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3249be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3250
aee96fe9
JM
3251This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3252handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3253of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
2a1ee410 3254to be emitted.
a2c4f8e0 3255@end defmac
2a1ee410 3256
8662eb14 3257@defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
44082375 3258This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
7c16328b
RH
3259code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3260available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3261through signal frames.
3262
614e5a7d
BE
3263This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3264@file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3265@file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
7c16328b
RH
3266@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3267for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
614e5a7d
BE
3268the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3269save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3270evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3271the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
8207b189
FS
3272
3273For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3274@code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
a2c4f8e0 3275@end defmac
861bb6c1 3276
3950dcdf
JJ
3277@defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3278This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3279call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3280usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3281
0c93ed52
SB
3282This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in libgcc's
3283@file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3950dcdf
JJ
3284@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3285for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3286@code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3287be updated in @var{fs}.
3288@end defmac
3289
4746cf84
MA
3290@defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3291A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3292info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3293linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3294@end defmac
3295
861bb6c1
JL
3296@node Stack Checking
3297@subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3298
b38f3813
EB
3299GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3300stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3301three ways:
861bb6c1
JL
3302
3303@enumerate
3304@item
a3a15b4d 3305If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
b38f3813
EB
3306will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3307at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3308other special processing.
861bb6c1
JL
3309
3310@item
b38f3813
EB
3311If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3312@code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3313that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3314static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3315in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3316stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3317approach below.
861bb6c1
JL
3318
3319@item
a3a15b4d 3320If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
861bb6c1
JL
3321``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3322@end enumerate
3323
b38f3813
EB
3324If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3325GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3326@option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3327dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
861bb6c1 3328
a2c4f8e0 3329@defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
861bb6c1 3330A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
02f52e19 3331machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
65a324b4 3332is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
b38f3813
EB
3333checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3334value of this macro is zero.
3335@end defmac
3336
3337@defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3338A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3339in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3340like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3341approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
a2c4f8e0 3342@end defmac
861bb6c1 3343
d809253a
EB
3344@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3345An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3346instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3347define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3348the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3349of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
a2c4f8e0 3350@end defmac
861bb6c1 3351
d809253a
EB
3352@defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3353An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3354when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3355contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3356thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3357is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3358default value of this macro is zero.
3359@end defmac
3360
a2c4f8e0 3361@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
507d0069
EB
3362The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3363languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 75 words
3364with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
33658192 bytes with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for
3366most machines.
a2c4f8e0 3367@end defmac
861bb6c1 3368
b38f3813
EB
3369The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3370nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3371in the opposite case.
3372
a2c4f8e0 3373@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
a3a15b4d 3374The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
861bb6c1
JL
3375instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3376stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
a3a15b4d
JL
3377checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3378default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
861bb6c1 3379systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
a2c4f8e0 3380@end defmac
861bb6c1 3381
a2c4f8e0 3382@defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
a3a15b4d 3383GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
861bb6c1
JL
3384represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3385space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3386You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3387use the default of four words.
a2c4f8e0 3388@end defmac
861bb6c1 3389
a2c4f8e0 3390@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
a3a15b4d 3391The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
861bb6c1 3392fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
630d3d5a 3393@option{-fstack-check}.
a3a15b4d 3394GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
861bb6c1 3395normally not need to override that default.
a2c4f8e0 3396@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
3397
3398@need 2000
3399@node Frame Registers
3400@subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3401
3402@c prevent bad page break with this line
3403This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3404
a2c4f8e0 3405@defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
3406The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3407fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3408the hardware determines which register this is.
a2c4f8e0 3409@end defmac
feca2ed3 3410
a2c4f8e0 3411@defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
3412The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3413access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3414hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3415choose any register you wish for this purpose.
a2c4f8e0 3416@end defmac
feca2ed3 3417
a2c4f8e0 3418@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
3419On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3420offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3421allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3422between these two locations). On those machines, define
3423@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3424be used internally until the offset is known, and define
556e0f21 3425@code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
feca2ed3
JW
3426used for the frame pointer.
3427
3428You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3429is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3430the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3431completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3432definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3433@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3434or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3435
3436Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3437@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
a2c4f8e0 3438@end defmac
feca2ed3 3439
a2c4f8e0 3440@defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
3441The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3442the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3443frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3444register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3445wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3446pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3447@code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3448(@pxref{Elimination}).
a2c4f8e0 3449@end defmac
feca2ed3 3450
e3339d0f
JM
3451@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3452Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3453@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3454the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3455== FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3456definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3457@end defmac
3458
3459@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3460Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3461@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3462same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3463ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3464definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3465@end defmac
3466
a2c4f8e0 3467@defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
3468The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3469access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3470machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3471pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3472to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3473@code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3474
3475Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3476address from the stack.
a2c4f8e0 3477@end defmac
feca2ed3 3478
a2c4f8e0
ZW
3479@defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3480@defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
3481Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3482register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3483function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3484number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3485these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
bd819a4a 3486not be defined.
feca2ed3
JW
3487
3488The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3489
3490If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
2b4fa409 3491defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
a2c4f8e0 3492@end defmac
919543ab 3493
c21df29b 3494@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN (const_tree @var{fndecl_or_type}, bool @var{incoming_p})
531ca746
RH
3495This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3496targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3497nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3498attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3499those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3500
3501The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
2b4fa409
RH
3502
3503If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3504provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3505Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3506from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3507will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3508@findex stack_pointer_rtx
3509@findex frame_pointer_rtx
3510@findex arg_pointer_rtx
3511The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3512@code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3513to refer to those items.
531ca746
RH
3514@end deftypefn
3515
a2c4f8e0 3516@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
919543ab
AH
3517This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3518saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3519DWARF2 exception handling.
3520
3521Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3522exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3523extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3524in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3525used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3526routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3527registers that are not call-saved.
3528
3529If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3530@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
a2c4f8e0 3531@end defmac
919543ab 3532
a2c4f8e0 3533@defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
919543ab
AH
3534
3535This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3536for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3537
3538If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3539@code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
a2c4f8e0 3540@end defmac
919543ab 3541
a2c4f8e0 3542@defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
41f3a930
AH
3543
3544Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3545is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
61aeb06f 3546Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
41f3a930
AH
3547column number to use instead.
3548
73774972 3549See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
a2c4f8e0 3550@end defmac
feca2ed3 3551
34c80057
AM
3552@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3553
3554Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3555used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
2dd76960 3556debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
34c80057
AM
3557should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3558@code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3559
3560@end defmac
3561
3562@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3563
3564Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
2dd76960 3565that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
34c80057 3566should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
f676971a 3567.eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
34c80057
AM
3568return @code{@var{regno}}.
3569
3570@end defmac
3571
cca2207a
L
3572@defmac REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3573
3574Define this macro if the target stores register values as
3575@code{_Unwind_Word} type in unwind context. It should be defined if
3576target register size is larger than the size of @code{void *}. The
3577default is to store register values as @code{void *} type.
3578
3579@end defmac
3580
3581@defmac ASSUME_EXTENDED_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3582
3583Define this macro to be 1 if the target always uses extended unwind
3584context with version, args_size and by_value fields. If it is undefined,
3585it will be defined to 1 when @code{REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT} is
3586defined and 0 otherwise.
3587
3588@end defmac
3589
feca2ed3
JW
3590@node Elimination
3591@subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3592
3593@c prevent bad page break with this line
3594This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3595
b52b1749
AS
3596@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED (void)
3597This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3598a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3599value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
feca2ed3 3600
b52b1749 3601This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
aea88c05
AS
3602according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3603constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3604to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3605Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3606pointer.
feca2ed3
JW
3607
3608In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3609without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3610automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
b52b1749 3611@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} returns. You don't need to worry about
bd819a4a 3612them.
feca2ed3
JW
3613
3614In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3615register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3616fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
aea88c05 3617
b52b1749
AS
3618Default return value is @code{false}.
3619@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 3620
feca2ed3 3621@findex get_frame_size
a2c4f8e0 3622@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
feca2ed3
JW
3623A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3624between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3625the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3626such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3627registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3628
3629If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3630need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
65a324b4 3631@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
feca2ed3 3632case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
a2c4f8e0 3633@end defmac
feca2ed3 3634
a2c4f8e0 3635@defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
feca2ed3
JW
3636If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3637eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3638defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3639references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3640
3641The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3642of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3643
3644On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3645the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3646must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3647replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3648depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3649
3650In this case, you might specify:
3ab51846 3651@smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
3652#define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3653@{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3654 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3655 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3ab51846 3656@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
3657
3658Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3659specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
a2c4f8e0 3660@end defmac
feca2ed3 3661
9ddb66ef 3662@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE (const int @var{from_reg}, const int @var{to_reg})
7b5cbb57 3663This target hook should returns @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
9ddb66ef
JR
3664try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3665@var{to_reg}. This target hook need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3be639f7 3666is defined, and will usually be @code{true}, since most of the cases
feca2ed3
JW
3667preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3668knows about.
3be639f7 3669
7b5cbb57
AS
3670Default return value is @code{true}.
3671@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 3672
a2c4f8e0 3673@defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
feca2ed3
JW
3674This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3675specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3676registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3677defined.
a2c4f8e0 3678@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
3679
3680@node Stack Arguments
3681@subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3682@cindex arguments on stack
3683@cindex stack arguments
3684
3685The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3686on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3687control passing certain arguments in registers.
3688
9ddb66ef 3689@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES (const_tree @var{fntype})
61f71b34
DD
3690This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3691prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3692passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3693cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3694The default is to not promote prototypes.
3695@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 3696
a2c4f8e0 3697@defmac PUSH_ARGS
767094dd 3698A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
f73ad30e
JH
3699outgoing arguments.
3700If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3701That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3702allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
aee96fe9 3703it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
a2c4f8e0 3704@end defmac
f73ad30e 3705
9d6bef95
JM
3706@defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3707A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3708last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3709defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3710and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3711@end defmac
3712
a2c4f8e0 3713@defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
feca2ed3
JW
3714A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3715stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
feca2ed3
JW
3716
3717On some machines, the definition
3718
3ab51846 3719@smallexample
feca2ed3 3720#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3ab51846 3721@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
3722
3723@noindent
3724will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3725to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3726alignment. Then the definition should be
3727
3ab51846 3728@smallexample
feca2ed3 3729#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3ab51846 3730@end smallexample
4a6336ad 3731
64ad7c99 3732If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
a2c4f8e0 3733@end defmac
feca2ed3 3734
29454ff5
SL
3735@findex outgoing_args_size
3736@findex crtl->outgoing_args_size
a2c4f8e0 3737@defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
767094dd 3738A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
29454ff5
SL
3739will be computed and placed into
3740@code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
feca2ed3
JW
3741onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3742increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3743
f73ad30e 3744Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
feca2ed3 3745is not proper.
a2c4f8e0 3746@end defmac
feca2ed3 3747
a2c4f8e0 3748@defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
feca2ed3
JW
3749Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3750allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3751registers.
3752
3753The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
ab87f8c8 3754arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
a3a15b4d 3755which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
5d059ed9
KT
3756The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3757of the function.
feca2ed3
JW
3758
3759This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3760machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3761which.
a2c4f8e0 3762@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
3763@c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3764@c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3765
ddbb449f
AM
3766@defmac INCOMING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3767Like @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, but for incoming register arguments.
3768Define this macro if space guaranteed when compiling a function body
3769is different to space required when making a call, a situation that
3770can arise with K&R style function definitions.
3771@end defmac
3772
81464b2c
KT
3773@defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3774Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3775caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3776when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3777if the function called is a library function.
feca2ed3
JW
3778
3779If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3780whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
29454ff5 3781@code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}.
a2c4f8e0 3782@end defmac
feca2ed3 3783
a2c4f8e0 3784@defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
feca2ed3
JW
3785Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3786stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3787@c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3788@c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3789
3790Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3791stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3792suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3793stack in its natural location.
a2c4f8e0 3794@end defmac
feca2ed3 3795
893d13d5 3796@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS (tree @var{fundecl}, tree @var{funtype}, int @var{size})
079e7538
NF
3797This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3798a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3799and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
feca2ed3
JW
3800
3801@var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3802the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3803@code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
91d231cb 3804From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
feca2ed3
JW
3805
3806@var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3807describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3808@code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3809From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3810arguments (if known).
3811
861bb6c1 3812When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
feca2ed3
JW
3813will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3814you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3815by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3816a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3817in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3818
893d13d5 3819@var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
feca2ed3
JW
3820stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3821argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3822
8aeea6e6 3823On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
893d13d5 3824of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
feca2ed3
JW
3825calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3826the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3827convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3828arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3829nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3830@var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3831number of arguments.
079e7538 3832@end deftypefn
fa5322fa 3833
a2c4f8e0 3834@defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
fa5322fa
AO
3835A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3836pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3837when compiling a function call.
3838
3839@var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3840have been accumulated.
3841
3842On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3843that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3844that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3845call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3846appropriate.
a2c4f8e0 3847@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
3848
3849@node Register Arguments
3850@subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3851@cindex arguments in registers
3852@cindex registers arguments
3853
3854This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3855types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3856the stack.
3857
ef4bddc2 3858@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
b25b9e8f
NF
3859Return an RTX indicating whether a function argument is passed in a
3860register and if so, which register.
feca2ed3 3861
b25b9e8f 3862The arguments are @var{ca}, which summarizes all the previous
feca2ed3
JW
3863arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3864the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3865(which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
b25b9e8f
NF
3866which is @code{true} for an ordinary argument and @code{false} for
3867nameless arguments that correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called
3868function's prototype. @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a
3869syntax error has previously occurred.
feca2ed3 3870
b25b9e8f
NF
3871The return value is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3872register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the argument
3873on the stack.
feca2ed3 3874
d5e254e1
IE
3875The return value can be a @code{const_int} which means argument is
3876passed in a target specific slot with specified number. Target hooks
3877should be used to store or load argument in such case. See
3878@code{TARGET_STORE_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG} and @code{TARGET_LOAD_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG}
3879for more information.
3880
161d7b59 3881The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
feca2ed3 3882used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
ce376beb 3883@code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
feca2ed3 3884@code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
f797c10b
NC
3885describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
3886@code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3887register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
3888register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
3889second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
3890the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
02f52e19 3891As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
c980b85b
NC
3892RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
3893argument is also stored on the stack.
feca2ed3 3894
b25b9e8f 3895The last time this hook is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
1cc5e432
GK
3896VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
3897pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
3898
feca2ed3 3899@cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
b25b9e8f
NF
3900The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a
3901machine where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to
3902cause nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is
3903done by making @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever
3904@var{named} is @code{false}.
3905
3906@cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
3907@cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
fe984136 3908You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
feca2ed3
JW
3909in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
3910type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
b25b9e8f 3911is not defined and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
feca2ed3
JW
3912argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
3913defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
3914a register.
b25b9e8f 3915@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 3916
ef4bddc2 3917@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
fe984136
RH
3918This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
3919solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
d9a4ee00
JL
3920definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
3921documentation.
fe984136 3922@end deftypefn
d9a4ee00 3923
ef4bddc2 3924@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
b25b9e8f 3925Define this hook if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
feca2ed3
JW
3926that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
3927necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
3928argument.
3929
b25b9e8f
NF
3930For such machines, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in
3931which the caller passes the value, and
3932@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should be defined in a similar
3933fashion to tell the function being called where the arguments will
3934arrive.
feca2ed3 3935
b25b9e8f
NF
3936If @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined,
3937@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} serves both purposes.
3938@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 3939
bcb21886
KY
3940@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_PSEUDO_PIC_REG (void)
3941This hook should return 1 in case pseudo register should be created
3942for pic_offset_table_rtx during function expand.
3943@end deftypefn
3944
3945@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_PIC_REG (void)
3946Perform a target dependent initialization of pic_offset_table_rtx.
3947This hook is called at the start of register allocation.
3948@end deftypefn
3949
ef4bddc2 3950@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
78a52f11
RH
3951This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
3952argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
feca2ed3
JW
3953arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
3954pushed on the stack.
3955
3956On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
3957registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
78a52f11 3958first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
feca2ed3
JW
3959on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
3960structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
3961in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
78a52f11 3962compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
feca2ed3 3963
b25b9e8f 3964@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
feca2ed3 3965register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
b25b9e8f 3966@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
78a52f11 3967@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 3968
ef4bddc2 3969@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
f676971a 3970This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
8cd5a4e0 3971position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
f676971a 3972predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
8cd5a4e0
RH
3973passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
3974
3975If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
feca2ed3
JW
3976pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
3977The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
3978to that type.
8cd5a4e0 3979@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 3980
ef4bddc2 3981@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
6cdd5672
RH
3982The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
3983known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
3984function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
3985by the caller.
3986
a1c496cb 3987For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
6cdd5672
RH
3988determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
3989not be generated.
3990
3991The default version of this hook always returns false.
3992@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 3993
a2c4f8e0 3994@defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
b25b9e8f
NF
3995A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument
3996of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some
3997target machines, the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number
3998of bytes of argument so far.
feca2ed3
JW
3999
4000There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4001arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4002variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4003arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4004@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4005should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
a2c4f8e0 4006@end defmac
feca2ed3 4007
7c800926
KT
4008@defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4009If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4010function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4011created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4012reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4013If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4014@var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4015@end defmac
4016
0f6937fe 4017@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
a2c4f8e0
ZW
4018A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4019@var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4020variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4021is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4022the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4023For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4024declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4025@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
0f6937fe
AM
4026being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4027arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4028parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
78466c0e 4029@var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
feca2ed3
JW
4030
4031When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4032@var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4033contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4034an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4035macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4036never both of them at once.
a2c4f8e0 4037@end defmac
feca2ed3 4038
a2c4f8e0 4039@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
97fc4caf
AO
4040Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4041it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4042@code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4043is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
40440)} is used instead.
a2c4f8e0 4045@end defmac
97fc4caf 4046
a2c4f8e0 4047@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
feca2ed3
JW
4048Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4049finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4050undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4051
4052The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
161d7b59 4053with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
feca2ed3
JW
4054argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4055@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4056@c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4057@c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
a2c4f8e0 4058@end defmac
feca2ed3 4059
ef4bddc2 4060@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
b25b9e8f
NF
4061This hook updates the summarizer variable pointed to by @var{ca} to
4062advance past an argument in the argument list. The values @var{mode},
4063@var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument. Once this is done,
4064the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing the @emph{following}
4065argument with @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
feca2ed3 4066
b25b9e8f 4067This hook need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
feca2ed3
JW
4068on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4069used for arguments without any special help.
b25b9e8f 4070@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 4071
099590dc
MM
4072@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4073If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4074offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4075which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4076slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4077top.
4078@end defmac
4079
a2c4f8e0 4080@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
feca2ed3
JW
4081If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4082to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4083@code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4084@code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4085
123148b5
BS
4086The @emph{amount} of padding is not controlled by this macro, but by the
4087target hook @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY}. It is
4088always just enough to reach the next multiple of that boundary.
feca2ed3
JW
4089
4090This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4091For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4092big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4093constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
a2c4f8e0 4094@end defmac
feca2ed3 4095
a2c4f8e0 4096@defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
02f52e19
AJ
4097If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4098implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
5e4f6244
CP
4099next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4100controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4101arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
a2c4f8e0 4102@end defmac
5e4f6244 4103
6e985040
AM
4104@defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4105Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4106memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4107macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4108machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4109@code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4110registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4111a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4112required.
4113@end defmac
4114
ef4bddc2 4115@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
2b0d3573 4116This hook returns the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
c2ed6cf8
NF
4117with the specified mode and type. The default hook returns
4118@code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4119@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 4120
ef4bddc2 4121@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
123148b5
BS
4122Normally, the size of an argument is rounded up to @code{PARM_BOUNDARY},
4123which is the default value for this hook. You can define this hook to
4124return a different value if an argument size must be rounded to a larger
4125value.
4126@end deftypefn
4127
a2c4f8e0 4128@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
feca2ed3
JW
4129A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4130register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4131@emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4132the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4133used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4134stack.
a2c4f8e0 4135@end defmac
bb1b857a 4136
9ddb66ef 4137@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG (const_tree @var{type})
42ba5130
RH
4138This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4139as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4140arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4141to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4142AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4143registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4144point register.
4145
4146The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4147false.
4148@end deftypefn
ded9bf77 4149
d3da4d14
RH
4150@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST (void)
4151This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4152The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4153@end deftypefn
4154
07a5b2bc 4155@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P (int @var{idx}, const char **@var{pname}, tree *@var{ptree})
d4048208
KT
4156This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4157to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4158variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
07a5b2bc 4159to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
d4048208 4160variable.
07a5b2bc 4161The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
d4048208
KT
4162this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4163internal type.
4164If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4165Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4166macro to iterate through all types.
4167@end deftypefn
4168
35cbb299
KT
4169@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST (tree @var{fndecl})
4170This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4171@var{fndecl}.
4172The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4173@end deftypefn
4174
4175@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE (tree @var{type})
4176This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4177type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4178@code{NULL_TREE}.
4179@end deftypefn
4180
9ddb66ef 4181@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR (tree @var{valist}, tree @var{type}, gimple_seq *@var{pre_p}, gimple_seq *@var{post_p})
23a60a04
JM
4182This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4183@code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4184arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4185@code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
23a60a04
JM
4186@end deftypefn
4187
ef4bddc2 4188@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
e09ec166
EC
4189Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4190with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4191hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4192@end deftypefn
4193
84562394 4194@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REF_MAY_ALIAS_ERRNO (struct ao_ref *@var{ref})
7352c013
RG
4195Define this to return nonzero if the memory reference @var{ref} may alias with the system C library errno location. The default version of this hook assumes the system C library errno location is either a declaration of type int or accessed by dereferencing a pointer to int.
4196@end deftypefn
4197
ef4bddc2 4198@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
6dd53648
RH
4199Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4200insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4201considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4202must work.
4203
4204The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4205required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4206Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4207code in @file{optabs.c}.
4208@end deftypefn
4209
ef4bddc2 4210@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
f676971a
EC
4211Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4212insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4213must have move patterns for this mode.
4214@end deftypefn
4215
ef4bddc2 4216@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{nelems})
0f6d54f7
RS
4217Return true if GCC should try to use a scalar mode to store an array
4218of @var{nelems} elements, given that each element has mode @var{mode}.
4219Returning true here overrides the usual @code{MAX_FIXED_MODE} limit
4220and allows GCC to use any defined integer mode.
4221
4222One use of this hook is to support vector load and store operations
4223that operate on several homogeneous vectors. For example, ARM NEON
4224has operations like:
4225
4226@smallexample
4227int8x8x3_t vld3_s8 (const int8_t *)
4228@end smallexample
4229
4230where the return type is defined as:
4231
4232@smallexample
4233typedef struct int8x8x3_t
4234@{
4235 int8x8_t val[3];
4236@} int8x8x3_t;
4237@end smallexample
4238
4239If this hook allows @code{val} to have a scalar mode, then
4240@code{int8x8x3_t} can have the same mode. GCC can then store
4241@code{int8x8x3_t}s in registers rather than forcing them onto the stack.
4242@end deftypefn
4243
ef4bddc2 4244@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBGCC_FLOATING_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
8cc4b7a2
JM
4245Define this to return nonzero if libgcc provides support for the
4246floating-point mode @var{mode}, which is known to pass
4247@code{TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P}. The default version of this
4248hook returns true for all of @code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode},
4249@code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode}, if such modes exist.
4250@end deftypefn
4251
ef4bddc2 4252@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
42db504c
SB
4253Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4254small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4255@var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4256in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4257In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4258for any mode.
4259
4260On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4261insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4262to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4263if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4264insn.
4265
4266Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4267in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4268the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4269classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4270registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4271registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4272SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4273strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4274machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4275
2b0d3573 4276The default version of this hook returns false for any mode. It is always
42db504c
SB
4277safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4278unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4279that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4280to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4281of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4282@end deftypefn
4283
feca2ed3
JW
4284@node Scalar Return
4285@subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4286@cindex return values in registers
4287@cindex values, returned by functions
4288@cindex scalars, returned as values
4289
4290This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4291values---values that can fit in registers.
4292
9ddb66ef 4293@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
1b03c58a
RG
4294
4295Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4296returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
e4ae5e77 4297representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
1b03c58a
RG
4298representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4299function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4300compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4301Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4302a function returns a value.
4303
4304On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4305(Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4306place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4307@code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4308The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
b25b9e8f 4309multiple places. See @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
576c9028
KH
4310@code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4311location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4312the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4313that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4314port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4315@samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
1b03c58a
RG
4316
4317If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4318the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4319@var{valtype} is a scalar type.
feca2ed3
JW
4320
4321If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4322node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4323pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4324convention for specific functions when all their calls are
bd819a4a 4325known.
feca2ed3 4326
1b03c58a
RG
4327Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4328which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4329the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4330different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4331
4332@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4333aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
cea28603 4334@code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
1b03c58a
RG
4335@end deftypefn
4336
4337@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4338This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4339a new target instead.
a2c4f8e0 4340@end defmac
feca2ed3 4341
a2c4f8e0 4342@defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
feca2ed3 4343A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
dc672951 4344function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
feca2ed3
JW
4345
4346Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4347support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4348specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4349compiled.
a2c4f8e0 4350@end defmac
feca2ed3 4351
ef4bddc2 4352@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{fun})
390b17c2 4353Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
ff2ce160 4354function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
390b17c2
RE
4355
4356The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
ff2ce160 4357library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
390b17c2
RE
4358representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4359
4360If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4361@end deftypefn
4362
a2c4f8e0 4363@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
feca2ed3
JW
4364A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4365register in which the values of called function may come back.
4366
4367A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4368second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4369recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4370suffices:
4371
3ab51846 4372@smallexample
feca2ed3 4373#define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
3ab51846 4374@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
4375
4376If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4377function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4378should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
82f81f18
AS
4379
4380This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4381for a new target instead.
a2c4f8e0 4382@end defmac
feca2ed3 4383
82f81f18
AS
4384@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (const unsigned int @var{regno})
4385A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4386register in which the values of called function may come back.
4387
4388A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4389second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4390recognized by this target hook.
4391
4392If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4393function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4394should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4395
4396If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4397@end deftypefn
4398
a2c4f8e0 4399@defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
4400Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4401need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4402saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
a2c4f8e0 4403@end defmac
feca2ed3 4404
e0d14c39
BS
4405@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OMIT_STRUCT_RETURN_REG
4406Normally, when a function returns a structure by memory, the address
4407is passed as an invisible pointer argument, but the compiler also
4408arranges to return the address from the function like it would a normal
4409pointer return value. Define this to true if that behaviour is
4410undesirable on your target.
4411@end deftypevr
4412
9ddb66ef 4413@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB (const_tree @var{type})
c988af2b
RS
4414This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4415at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4416padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4417is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4418
1b03c58a
RG
4419Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4420be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4421or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
44224-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4423@code{SImode} rtx.
c988af2b
RS
4424@end deftypefn
4425
feca2ed3
JW
4426@node Aggregate Return
4427@subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4428@cindex aggregates as return values
4429@cindex large return values
4430@cindex returning aggregate values
4431@cindex structure value address
4432
4433When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
1b03c58a
RG
4434cases), the value is not returned according to
4435@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4436caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4437should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4438address}.
feca2ed3
JW
4439
4440This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4441memory.
4442
9ddb66ef 4443@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY (const_tree @var{type}, const_tree @var{fntype})
61f71b34
DD
4444This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4445function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4446Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4447will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4448libcalls.
feca2ed3
JW
4449
4450Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
61f71b34 4451by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
feca2ed3 4452takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
61f71b34 4453possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
feca2ed3
JW
4454definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4455values, and 0 otherwise.
4456
61f71b34 4457Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
feca2ed3
JW
4458be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4459to indicate this.
61f71b34 4460@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 4461
a2c4f8e0 4462@defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
feca2ed3
JW
4463Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4464in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
161d7b59 4465only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
feca2ed3 4466If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
d624465f
KH
4467and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4468target hook.
feca2ed3
JW
4469
4470If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
a2c4f8e0 4471@end defmac
feca2ed3 4472
61f71b34
DD
4473@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{incoming})
4474This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4475address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4476passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
1f6acb82
KH
4477be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4478hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4479argument.
feca2ed3 4480
feca2ed3
JW
4481On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4482is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4483caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4484be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
2225b57c
CD
4485@var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4486the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
61f71b34 4487the caller.
feca2ed3 4488
917f1b7e 4489If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
2225b57c
CD
4490stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4491@var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
64ee9490 4492structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
2225b57c 4493to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
61f71b34 4494@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 4495
a2c4f8e0 4496@defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
feca2ed3
JW
4497Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4498for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4499the address of a static variable containing the value.
4500
4501Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4502pass an address to the subroutine.
4503
630d3d5a
JM
4504This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4505nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
a2c4f8e0 4506@end defmac
feca2ed3 4507
ef4bddc2 4508@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE (int @var{regno})
ffa88471
SE
4509This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw return registers in @code{__builtin_return}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4510@end deftypefn
4511
ef4bddc2 4512@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE (int @var{regno})
ffa88471
SE
4513This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw argument registers in @code{__builtin_apply_args}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4514@end deftypefn
4515
feca2ed3
JW
4516@node Caller Saves
4517@subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4518
a3a15b4d 4519If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
feca2ed3
JW
4520makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4521must live across calls.
4522
a2c4f8e0 4523@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
8d5c8167
JL
4524A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4525of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4526@var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4527returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4528will select the smallest suitable mode.
a2c4f8e0 4529@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
4530
4531@node Function Entry
4532@subsection Function Entry and Exit
4533@cindex function entry and exit
4534@cindex prologue
4535@cindex epilogue
4536
4537This section describes the macros that output function entry
4538(@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4539
08c148a8
NB
4540@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4541If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
feca2ed3
JW
4542function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4543initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4544saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4545local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4546stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4547
4548The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4549macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4550
4551@findex regs_ever_live
4552To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4553@code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4554@var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4555prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
08c148a8 4556call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
feca2ed3
JW
4557@code{regs_ever_live}.)
4558
4559On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4560not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4561they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4562appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4563registers are used in the function.
4564
4565@findex frame_pointer_needed
4566On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4567function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4568pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4569frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4570@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4571time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4572
4573The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4574required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4575listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4576order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4577stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4578the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4579for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4580compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4581or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4582need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
08c148a8
NB
4583@end deftypefn
4584
17b53c33
NB
4585@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4586If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4587prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4588emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4589emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4590@end deftypefn
4591
4592@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4593If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4594epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4595emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4596emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4597@end deftypefn
4598
08c148a8
NB
4599@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4600If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4601function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4602registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4603called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4604same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4605registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4606@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4607
4608On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4609of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4610instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4611@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4612
4613Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4614@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4615switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4616define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4617target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4618condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4619
4620On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4621function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4622two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4623is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4624@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4625a function that needs a frame pointer.
4626
4627Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4628@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4629The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4630function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4631
4632On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4633others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4634given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4635number of arguments.
4636
29454ff5
SL
4637@findex pops_args
4638@findex crtl->args.pops_args
08c148a8
NB
4639Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4640functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
72392b81
JR
4641needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4642function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4643@code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
08c148a8
NB
4644@end deftypefn
4645
feca2ed3
JW
4646@itemize @bullet
4647@item
29454ff5
SL
4648@findex pretend_args_size
4649@findex crtl->args.pretend_args_size
4650A region of @code{crtl->args.pretend_args_size} bytes of
feca2ed3
JW
4651uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4652stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4653if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4654arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4655yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4656region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4657registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
6c535c69 4658features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
feca2ed3
JW
4659
4660@item
4661An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4662The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4663the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4664machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4665in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4666a save area.
4667
4668@item
4669A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4670boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4671this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4672save area closer to the top of the stack.
4673
4674@item
4675@cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4676Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
29454ff5 4677@code{crtl->outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
feca2ed3
JW
4678argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4679@end itemize
4680
a2c4f8e0 4681@defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
feca2ed3
JW
4682Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4683instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4684pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
9d05bbce
KH
4685adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4686default is 0.
feca2ed3
JW
4687
4688Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4689frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4690stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4691compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
a2c4f8e0 4692@end defmac
feca2ed3 4693
a2c4f8e0 4694@defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
8760eaae 4695Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
feca2ed3 4696used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
86c33cd0 4697pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
a2c4f8e0 4698@end defmac
feca2ed3 4699
a2c4f8e0 4700@defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
15b5aef3
RH
4701Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4702used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4703on entry to an exception edge.
a2c4f8e0 4704@end defmac
15b5aef3 4705
65e71cd6 4706@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, tree @var{function})
483ab821 4707A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
feca2ed3
JW
4708function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4709inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4710adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4711the real function.
4712
4713First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4714contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4715contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4716in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
e979f9e8 4717e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
feca2ed3
JW
4718all other incoming arguments.
4719
65e71cd6
EB
4720Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4721made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4722adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4723
4724@smallexample
4725p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4726@end smallexample
4727
4728After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
feca2ed3
JW
4729@code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4730not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4731return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4732
4733The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4734the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
08c148a8
NB
4735of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4736and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
feca2ed3
JW
4737
4738The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4739have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4740some targets, but probably not.
4741
861bb6c1 4742If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
c771326b 4743front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
861bb6c1
JL
4744@var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4745not support varargs.
483ab821
MM
4746@end deftypefn
4747
9ddb66ef 4748@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (const_tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, const_tree @var{function})
65e71cd6
EB
4749A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4750to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4751arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4752generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4753previously exposed.
483ab821 4754@end deftypefn
feca2ed3
JW
4755
4756@node Profiling
4757@subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4758@cindex profiling, code generation
4759
4760These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4761
a2c4f8e0 4762@defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
feca2ed3
JW
4763A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4764assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
feca2ed3
JW
4765
4766@findex mcount
980e2067 4767The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
161d7b59 4768your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
980e2067
JL
4769compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4770compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4771
4772Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4773variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4774@samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4775the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
a2c4f8e0 4776@end defmac
980e2067 4777
a2c4f8e0 4778@defmac PROFILE_HOOK
411707f4
CC
4779A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4780code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4781not support profiling.
a2c4f8e0 4782@end defmac
411707f4 4783
a2c4f8e0 4784@defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
8b65a354
JZ
4785Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4786@code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4787allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4788implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4789@var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
a2c4f8e0 4790@end defmac
feca2ed3 4791
a2c4f8e0 4792@defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
feca2ed3
JW
4793Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4794the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
a2c4f8e0 4795@end defmac
feca2ed3 4796
d56a43a0
AK
4797@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_KEEP_LEAF_WHEN_PROFILED (void)
4798This target hook returns true if the target wants the leaf flag for the current function to stay true even if it calls mcount. This might make sense for targets using the leaf flag only to determine whether a stack frame needs to be generated or not and for which the call to mcount is generated before the function prologue.
4799@end deftypefn
4800
91d231cb
JM
4801@node Tail Calls
4802@subsection Permitting tail calls
4803@cindex tail calls
b36f4ed3 4804
4977bab6 4805@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{exp})
5bd40ade 4806True if it is OK to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4977bab6
ZW
4807call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4808or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4cb1433c
RH
4809
4810It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4811tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4977bab6 4812during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
02f52e19 4813as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4977bab6
ZW
4814``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4815may vary greatly between different architectures.
4816@end deftypefn
4cb1433c 4817
9ddb66ef 4818@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY (bitmap @var{regs})
912f2dac
DB
4819Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4820function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4821cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4822registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4823TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4824FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4825@end deftypefn
4826
ee3d2ecd
JJ
4827@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_UP_BY_PROLOGUE (struct hard_reg_set_container *@var{})
4828This hook should add additional registers that are computed by the prologue to the hard regset for shrink-wrapping optimization purposes.
4829@end deftypefn
4830
d45eae79
SL
4831@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WARN_FUNC_RETURN (tree)
4832True if a function's return statements should be checked for matching the function's return type. This includes checking for falling off the end of a non-void function. Return false if no such check should be made.
4833@end deftypefn
4834
7d69de61
RH
4835@node Stack Smashing Protection
4836@subsection Stack smashing protection
4837@cindex stack smashing protection
4838
4839@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD (void)
4840This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
083cad55 4841for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
7d69de61
RH
4842runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4843that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
4844variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4845
4846The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4847@samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4848@end deftypefn
4849
4850@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL (void)
b3c144a3 4851This hook returns a @code{CALL_EXPR} that alerts the runtime that the
7d69de61
RH
4852stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
4853involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
4854
4855The default version of this hook invokes a function called
083cad55 4856@samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
7d69de61
RH
4857normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4858@end deftypefn
4859
677f3fa8 4860@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK (bool @var{report}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
d5fabb58 4861Whether this target supports splitting the stack when the options described in @var{opts} have been passed. This is called after options have been parsed, so the target may reject splitting the stack in some configurations. The default version of this hook returns false. If @var{report} is true, this function may issue a warning or error; if @var{report} is false, it must simply return a value
7458026b
ILT
4862@end deftypefn
4863
aaeaa9a9
RO
4864@node Miscellaneous Register Hooks
4865@subsection Miscellaneous register hooks
4866@cindex miscellaneous register hooks
4867
4868@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALL_FUSAGE_CONTAINS_NON_CALLEE_CLOBBERS
73b3e61b
TV
4869Set to true if each call that binds to a local definition explicitly
4870clobbers or sets all non-fixed registers modified by performing the call.
4871That is, by the call pattern itself, or by code that might be inserted by the
4872linker (e.g. stubs, veneers, branch islands), but not including those
4873modifiable by the callee. The affected registers may be mentioned explicitly
4874in the call pattern, or included as clobbers in CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE.
4875The default version of this hook is set to false. The purpose of this hook
1e288103 4876is to enable the fipa-ra optimization.
aaeaa9a9
RO
4877@end deftypevr
4878
feca2ed3
JW
4879@node Varargs
4880@section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4881@cindex varargs implementation
4882
aee96fe9
JM
4883GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4884@code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
feca2ed3
JW
4885on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
4886varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4887conditionals to include it.
4888
aee96fe9 4889ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
feca2ed3
JW
4890the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
4891implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
5490d604 4892to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
feca2ed3
JW
4893@code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
4894supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4895
4896However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
4897the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
4898below.
4899
a2c4f8e0 4900@defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
feca2ed3 4901Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
5490d604 4902that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
feca2ed3 4903versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
c2379679 4904you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
feca2ed3
JW
4905
4906On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
f61c92c3
KH
4907control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
4908other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
4909found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
feca2ed3
JW
4910
4911Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
4912beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
4913@code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
4914This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
4915to use them for its own purposes.
4916@c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
4917@c 10feb93
a2c4f8e0 4918@end defmac
feca2ed3 4919
a2c4f8e0 4920@defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
c59a0a1d 4921This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
767094dd 4922argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
feca2ed3
JW
4923returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
4924argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
4925fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
4926verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
4927of the current function.
a2c4f8e0 4928@end defmac
feca2ed3 4929
a2c4f8e0 4930@defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
feca2ed3
JW
4931Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
4932passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
4933has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
4934specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
4935with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
4936
4937@code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
4938considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
4939kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
4940
4941The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
4942interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
a2c4f8e0 4943@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
4944
4945These machine description macros help implement varargs:
4946
61f71b34
DD
4947@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS (void)
4948If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
4949@code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
4950beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
4951return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
4952to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
4953@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 4954
ef4bddc2 4955@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
61f71b34
DD
4956This target hook offers an alternative to using
4957@code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
4958@code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
4959register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
4960have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
4961use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
4962pass all their arguments on the stack.
feca2ed3 4963
61f71b34 4964The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
8760eaae 4965structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
feca2ed3
JW
4966named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
4967last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
4968
61f71b34
DD
4969The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
4970argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
4971store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
4972variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
4973store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
4974frame.
feca2ed3
JW
4975
4976Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
4977compile time without knowing their data types,
61f71b34
DD
4978@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
4979have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
4980for all data types.
feca2ed3
JW
4981
4982If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
4983arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
4984happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
61f71b34 4985end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
feca2ed3 4986not generate any instructions in this case.
61f71b34 4987@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 4988
d5cc9181 4989@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
61f71b34 4990Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
e5e809f4 4991argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
feca2ed3 4992
b25b9e8f 4993This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
61f71b34
DD
4994is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
4995@code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
4996arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5b4ef0b1 4997but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
61f71b34
DD
4998then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
4999except the last are treated as named.
e5e809f4 5000
9ddb66ef 5001You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
61f71b34 5002@end deftypefn
9ab70a9b 5003
2f21e1ba
BS
5004@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CALL_ARGS (rtx, @var{tree})
5005While generating RTL for a function call, this target hook is invoked once
5006for each argument passed to the function, either a register returned by
5007@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} or a memory location. It is called just
5008before the point where argument registers are stored. The type of the
5009function to be called is also passed as the second argument; it is
5010@code{NULL_TREE} for libcalls. The @code{TARGET_END_CALL_ARGS} hook is
5011invoked just after the code to copy the return reg has been emitted.
5012This functionality can be used to perform special setup of call argument
5013registers if a target needs it.
5014For functions without arguments, the hook is called once with @code{pc_rtx}
5015passed instead of an argument register.
5016Most ports do not need to implement anything for this hook.
5017@end deftypefn
5018
5019@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_END_CALL_ARGS (void)
5020This target hook is invoked while generating RTL for a function call,
5021just after the point where the return reg is copied into a pseudo. It
5022signals that all the call argument and return registers for the just
5023emitted call are now no longer in use.
5024Most ports do not need to implement anything for this hook.
5025@end deftypefn
5026
d5cc9181 5027@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
9ab70a9b 5028If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
61f71b34
DD
5029@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5030@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5031defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
c2379679 5032@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
61f71b34
DD
5033Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5034@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 5035
d5e254e1
IE
5036@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LOAD_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG (rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{arg}, rtx @var{slot_no})
5037This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to load bounds of
5038@var{arg} passed in @var{slot}. Expand pass uses this hook in case
5039bounds of @var{arg} are not passed in register. If @var{slot} is a
5040memory, then bounds are loaded as for regular pointer loaded from
5041memory. If @var{slot} is not a memory then @var{slot_no} is an integer
5042constant holding number of the target dependent special slot which
5043should be used to obtain bounds. Hook returns RTX holding loaded bounds.
5044@end deftypefn
5045
5046@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_STORE_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG (rtx @var{arg}, rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{bounds}, rtx @var{slot_no})
5047This hook is used by expand pass to emit insns to store @var{bounds} of
5048@var{arg} passed in @var{slot}. Expand pass uses this hook in case
5049@var{bounds} of @var{arg} are not passed in register. If @var{slot} is a
5050memory, then @var{bounds} are stored as for regular pointer stored in
5051memory. If @var{slot} is not a memory then @var{slot_no} is an integer
5052constant holding number of the target dependent special slot which
5053should be used to store @var{bounds}.
5054@end deftypefn
5055
5056@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LOAD_RETURNED_BOUNDS (rtx @var{slot})
5057This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to load bounds
5058returned by function call in @var{slot}. Hook returns RTX holding
5059loaded bounds.
5060@end deftypefn
5061
5062@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_STORE_RETURNED_BOUNDS (rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{bounds})
5063This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to store @var{bounds}
5064returned by function call into @var{slot}.
5065@end deftypefn
5066
5067@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_CHKP_FUNCTION_VALUE_BOUNDS (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
5068Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
5069returns bounds for returned pointers. Arguments meaning is similar to
5070@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE}.
5071@end deftypefn
5072
5073@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARG_BOUNDS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
5074Use it to store bounds for anonymous register arguments stored
5075into the stack. Arguments meaning is similar to
5076@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}.
5077@end deftypefn
5078
feca2ed3
JW
5079@node Trampolines
5080@section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5081@cindex trampolines for nested functions
5082@cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5083
5084A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5085when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5086the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
a3a15b4d 5087tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
feca2ed3
JW
5088trampoline.
5089
5090The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5091address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5092the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5093two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5094exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5095machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5096two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5097operands.
5098
5099The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5100parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5101immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5102simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5103proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5104may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5105separately.
5106
531ca746
RH
5107@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (FILE *@var{f})
5108This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5109on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5110the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5111label---the label is taken care of automatically.
feca2ed3 5112
531ca746
RH
5113If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5114for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
feca2ed3
JW
5115code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5116to generate it on the spot.
531ca746 5117@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 5118
a2c4f8e0 5119@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
d6b5193b
RS
5120Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5121(@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
a2c4f8e0 5122@end defmac
feca2ed3 5123
a2c4f8e0 5124@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
feca2ed3 5125A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
a2c4f8e0 5126@end defmac
feca2ed3 5127
a2c4f8e0 5128@defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
feca2ed3
JW
5129Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5130
531ca746 5131If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
feca2ed3 5132is used for aligning trampolines.
a2c4f8e0 5133@end defmac
feca2ed3 5134
531ca746
RH
5135@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT (rtx @var{m_tramp}, tree @var{fndecl}, rtx @var{static_chain})
5136This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5137@var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5138is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
feca2ed3
JW
5139RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5140when it is called.
5141
531ca746
RH
5142If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5143first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5144from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
ff2ce160 5145Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
531ca746
RH
5146trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5147to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
b33493e3 5148
531ca746 5149If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
ff2ce160 5150enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
531ca746
RH
5151initializing the trampoline proper.
5152@end deftypefn
5153
5154@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (rtx @var{addr})
5155This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5156the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5157memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5158the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5159address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5160be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5161If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5162@end deftypefn
feca2ed3
JW
5163
5164Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5165separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5166fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5167jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5168
5169Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5170the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5171make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5172subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5173latter makes initialization faster.
5174
5175To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
f691dc3b 5176the following macro.
feca2ed3 5177
a2c4f8e0 5178@defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
feca2ed3 5179If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
f691dc3b
AJ
5180cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5181typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5182@var{end} are both pointer expressions.
a2c4f8e0 5183@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
5184
5185To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5186you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5187cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5188beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5189its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5190
a2c4f8e0 5191@defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
feca2ed3
JW
5192Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5193work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
161d7b59 5194which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
feca2ed3
JW
5195@code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5196
5197If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5198C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5199special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5200statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5201global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5202special assembler code.
a2c4f8e0 5203@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
5204
5205@node Library Calls
5206@section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5207@cindex library subroutine names
5208@cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5209
5210@c prevent bad page break with this line
5211Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5212
a2c4f8e0 5213@defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
d8088c6f
BS
5214This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5215expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
2dd76960 5216provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
d8088c6f 5217are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
a2c4f8e0 5218@end defmac
d8088c6f 5219
c15c90bb 5220@findex set_optab_libfunc
914d25dc 5221@findex init_one_libfunc
c15c90bb
ZW
5222@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS (void)
5223This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5224existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5225@code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5226@code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5227library routines.
feca2ed3 5228
c15c90bb
ZW
5229The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5230@end deftypefn
c5c60e15 5231
cdbf4541
BS
5232@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX
5233If false (the default), internal library routines start with two
5234underscores. If set to true, these routines start with @code{__gnu_}
5235instead. E.g., @code{__muldi3} changes to @code{__gnu_muldi3}. This
5236currently only affects functions defined in @file{libgcc2.c}. If this
5237is set to true, the @file{tm.h} file must also
5238@code{#define LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX}.
5239@end deftypevr
5240
9c917669 5241@defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
c15c90bb
ZW
5242This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5243implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5244mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5245return a tristate.
5246
5247GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5248comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5249don't need to define this macro.
5250@end defmac
5251
b3f8d95d
MM
5252@defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5253This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5254functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5255operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5256and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
38b974a6 5257If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
78466c0e 5258@minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
b3f8d95d
MM
5259in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5260@end defmac
5261
30b8f78b
KV
5262@defmac TARGET_HAS_NO_HW_DIVIDE
5263This macro should be defined if the target has no hardware divide
5264instructions. If this macro is defined, GCC will use an algorithm which
5265make use of simple logical and arithmetic operations for 64-bit
5266division. If the macro is not defined, GCC will use an algorithm which
5267make use of a 64-bit by 32-bit divide primitive.
5268@end defmac
5269
feca2ed3 5270@cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
a2c4f8e0
ZW
5271@findex matherr
5272@defmac TARGET_EDOM
feca2ed3 5273The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
a3a15b4d 5274expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
feca2ed3
JW
5275deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5276@file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5277system.
5278
5279If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5280domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5281error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5282there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5283that @code{matherr} is used normally.
a2c4f8e0 5284@end defmac
feca2ed3 5285
feca2ed3 5286@cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
a2c4f8e0 5287@defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
feca2ed3
JW
5288Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5289refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5290@code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5291macro, a reasonable default is used.
a2c4f8e0 5292@end defmac
feca2ed3 5293
d33d9e47
AI
5294@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBC_HAS_FUNCTION (enum function_class @var{fn_class})
5295This hook determines whether a function from a class of functions
5296@var{fn_class} is present at the runtime.
5297@end deftypefn
006339cd 5298
a2c4f8e0 5299@defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
fea3ca91
IS
5300Set this macro to 1 to use the "NeXT" Objective-C message sending conventions
5301by default. This calling convention involves passing the object, the selector
5302and the method arguments all at once to the method-lookup library function.
5303This is the usual setting when targeting Darwin/Mac OS X systems, which have
5304the NeXT runtime installed.
5305
5306If the macro is set to 0, the "GNU" Objective-C message sending convention
5307will be used by default. This convention passes just the object and the
5308selector to the method-lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5309
5310In either case, it remains possible to select code-generation for the alternate
5311scheme, by means of compiler command line switches.
a2c4f8e0 5312@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
5313
5314@node Addressing Modes
5315@section Addressing Modes
5316@cindex addressing modes
5317
5318@c prevent bad page break with this line
5319This is about addressing modes.
5320
a2c4f8e0
ZW
5321@defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5322@defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5323@defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5324@defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
df2a54e9 5325A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
7a6bd5ae 5326pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
a2c4f8e0 5327@end defmac
feca2ed3 5328
a2c4f8e0
ZW
5329@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5330@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
df2a54e9 5331A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
7a6bd5ae
JL
5332post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5333the size of the memory operand.
a2c4f8e0 5334@end defmac
864bcaa7 5335
a2c4f8e0
ZW
5336@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5337@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
df2a54e9 5338A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
7a6bd5ae 5339post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
a2c4f8e0 5340@end defmac
864bcaa7 5341
a2c4f8e0 5342@defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
feca2ed3 5343A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
65a324b4
NC
5344is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5345@code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5346is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
ff2ce160 5347constant addresses are supported.
a2c4f8e0 5348@end defmac
feca2ed3 5349
a2c4f8e0
ZW
5350@defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5351@code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5352accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5353known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5354expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5355@code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5356@end defmac
feca2ed3 5357
a2c4f8e0 5358@defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
feca2ed3
JW
5359A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5360memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
c6c3dba9 5361the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
feca2ed3 5362accept.
a2c4f8e0 5363@end defmac
feca2ed3 5364
ef4bddc2 5365@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, bool @var{strict})
c6c3dba9
PB
5366A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5367address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
feca2ed3 5368
c6c3dba9 5369Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
914d25dc 5370non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
c6c3dba9 5371desired by the caller.
feca2ed3 5372
c6c3dba9
PB
5373The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5374that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5375considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5376kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5377must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5378up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5379register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5380if the array holds @code{-1}.
feca2ed3
JW
5381
5382The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5383accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5384register is required.
5385
feca2ed3
JW
5386Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5387and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5388constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5389specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5390recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5391
5392Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5393sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5394@code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5395naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5396be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5397
fb49053f 5398@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
feca2ed3
JW
5399On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5400the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
fb49053f
RH
5401target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5402into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
feca2ed3
JW
5403@code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5404@code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5405Format}.
c6c3dba9
PB
5406
5407@cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5408Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5409this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5410has this syntax:
5411
5412@example
5413#define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5414@end example
5415
5416@noindent
5417and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5418address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
6f7b223b
PK
5419
5420@findex REG_OK_STRICT
5421Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5422macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
5423@code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5424that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5425
c6c3dba9
PB
5426Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5427files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5428@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 5429
a4edaf83
AK
5430@defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5431A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5432character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5433letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
c6c3dba9 5434@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
a4edaf83
AK
5435support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5436semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5437preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5438@code{'m'} constraint.
5439@end defmac
5440
a2c4f8e0 5441@defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
a9e6fc5a
RS
5442A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5443or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
53451050
RS
5444can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5445@code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
b949ea8b
JW
5446
5447It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5448that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5449
5450The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
161d7b59 5451a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
a2c4f8e0 5452@end defmac
b949ea8b 5453
ef4bddc2 5454@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, machine_mode @var{mode})
506d7b68
PB
5455This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5456operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5457address.
feca2ed3
JW
5458
5459@findex break_out_memory_refs
5460@var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5461and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5462@var{x}.
5463
506d7b68 5464The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
feca2ed3 5465@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
506d7b68 5466should return the new @var{x}.
feca2ed3 5467
f938987f
HPN
5468It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address,
5469with the exception of native TLS addresses (@pxref{Emulated TLS}).
5470The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, if
5471the target supports only emulated TLS, it
506d7b68
PB
5472is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5473a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5474strategy can generate better code.
5475@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 5476
a2c4f8e0 5477@defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
a9a2595b
JR
5478A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5479that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5480@var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5481It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
02f52e19 5482performance reasons.
a9a2595b
JR
5483
5484For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5485reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5486registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5487processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5488needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
aee96fe9 5489@code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
a9a2595b
JR
5490generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5491be shared.
5492
39bdfaa0
RH
5493@emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5494to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5495and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5496of reload internals.
a9a2595b 5497
5f0c590d
JL
5498@emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5499previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5500then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5501
a9a2595b 5502@findex push_reload
39bdfaa0
RH
5503The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5504need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5505suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
a9a2595b 5506
39bdfaa0 5507The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
a9a2595b
JR
5508@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5509should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5510This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5511@code{push_reload}.
5512
39bdfaa0
RH
5513@findex strict_memory_address_p
5514The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5515the address has become legitimate.
5516
a9a2595b
JR
5517@findex copy_rtx
5518If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
ab873839 5519this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
a9a2595b 5520single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
c771326b 5521top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
a9a2595b
JR
5522It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5523address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
a2c4f8e0 5524@end defmac
a9a2595b 5525
5bfed9a9
GJL
5526@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P (const_rtx @var{addr}, addr_space_t @var{addrspace})
5527This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} in address
5528space @var{addrspace} can have
cbda7dc6
AS
5529different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5530reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5531but not others.
5532
5533Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5534effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5535of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5536addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5537
5538You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5539
5540The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5541@end deftypefn
5542
ef4bddc2 5543@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
1a627b35
RS
5544This hook returns true if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for a
5545@var{mode}-mode immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5546@var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.
5547
5548The default definition returns true.
5549@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 5550
73f8783a
RS
5551@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x})
5552This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5553@code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5554macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5555references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5556addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5557the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5558into their original form.
5559@end deftypefn
93bcc8c9
JJ
5560
5561@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CONST_NOT_OK_FOR_DEBUG_P (rtx @var{x})
5562This hook should return true if @var{x} should not be emitted into
5563debug sections.
5564@end deftypefn
73f8783a 5565
ef4bddc2 5566@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
d3da4d14 5567This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
fbbf66e7
RS
5568should not) be spilled to the constant pool. @var{mode} is the mode
5569of @var{x}.
5570
5571The default version of this hook returns false.
d3da4d14
RH
5572
5573The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5574deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5575from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5576holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5577of TLS symbols for various targets.
5578@end deftypefn
5579
ef4bddc2 5580@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{x})
aacd3885
RS
5581This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5582be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5583of @var{x}.
5584
5585The default version returns false for all constants.
5586@end deftypefn
5587
361a58da
DE
5588@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_DECL_P (const_tree @var{decl})
5589This hook should return true if pool entries for @var{decl} should
5590be placed in an @code{object_block} structure.
5591
5592The default version returns true for all decls.
5593@end deftypefn
5594
5eb7ce91 5595@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL (unsigned @var{fn}, bool @var{md_fn}, bool @var{sqrt})
6b889d89 5596This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements reciprocal of
ac10986f 5597the builtin function with builtin function code @var{fn}, or
5eb7ce91 5598@code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available. @var{md_fn} is true
ac10986f
UB
5599when @var{fn} is a code of a machine-dependent builtin function. When
5600@var{sqrt} is true, additional optimizations that apply only to the reciprocal
5601of a square root function are performed, and only reciprocals of @code{sqrt}
5602function are valid.
6b889d89
UB
5603@end deftypefn
5604
d16b59fa
DN
5605@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD (void)
5606This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5607address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
083cad55 5608used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
d16b59fa
DN
5609@var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5610
ab873839 5611The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
d16b59fa
DN
5612@var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5613the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5614@code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5615two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5616@var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5617the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5618from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
083cad55
EC
5619@var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5620@var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
d16b59fa
DN
5621@var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5622
5623If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5624to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5625use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5626@code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
083cad55 5627should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
d16b59fa
DN
5628described above.
5629If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5630the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
8ad1dde7 5631log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
d16b59fa
DN
5632@end deftypefn
5633
720f5239 5634@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST (enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{type_of_cost}, tree @var{vectype}, int @var{misalign})
35e1a5e7 5635Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
ff2ce160 5636For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
720f5239 5637misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
a934eb2d
JR
5638@end deftypefn
5639
5640@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE (const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{is_packed})
5641Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5642@end deftypefn
5643
ef4bddc2 5644@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VEC_PERM_CONST_OK (machine_mode, const unsigned char *@var{sel})
5dea5b2a 5645Return true if a vector created for @code{vec_perm_const} is valid.
a934eb2d
JR
5646@end deftypefn
5647
88dd7150 5648@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{dest_type}, tree @var{src_type})
f57d17f1 5649This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
88dd7150 5650input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
a934eb2d
JR
5651The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5652specifies how the conversion is to be applied
f57d17f1
TM
5653(truncation, rounding, etc.).
5654
5655If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5656@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5657conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5658@end deftypefn
5659
62f7fd21
MM
5660@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
5661This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5662vectorized variant of the builtin function with builtin function code
5663@var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5664The value of @var{fndecl} is the builtin function declaration. The
5665return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5666@var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
2505a3f2
RG
5667@end deftypefn
5668
ef4bddc2 5669@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, int @var{misalignment}, bool @var{is_packed})
0601d0cf
RE
5670This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5671store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5672parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5673the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5674parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5675@end deftypefn
5676
ef4bddc2 5677@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
cc4b5170
RG
5678This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5679mode @var{mode}. The default is
5680equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
26983c22
L
5681transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5682@end deftypefn
5683
767f865f
RG
5684@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES (void)
5685This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5686after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5687mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5688The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5689@end deftypefn
5690
c3e7ee41 5691@deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST (struct loop *@var{loop_info})
92345349 5692This hook should initialize target-specific data structures in preparation for modeling the costs of vectorizing a loop or basic block. The default allocates three unsigned integers for accumulating costs for the prologue, body, and epilogue of the loop or basic block. If @var{loop_info} is non-NULL, it identifies the loop being vectorized; otherwise a single block is being vectorized.
c3e7ee41
BS
5693@end deftypefn
5694
92345349
BS
5695@deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_VECTORIZE_ADD_STMT_COST (void *@var{data}, int @var{count}, enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{kind}, struct _stmt_vec_info *@var{stmt_info}, int @var{misalign}, enum vect_cost_model_location @var{where})
5696This hook should update the target-specific @var{data} in response to adding @var{count} copies of the given @var{kind} of statement to a loop or basic block. The default adds the builtin vectorizer cost for the copies of the statement to the accumulator specified by @var{where}, (the prologue, body, or epilogue) and returns the amount added. The return value should be viewed as a tentative cost that may later be revised.
c3e7ee41
BS
5697@end deftypefn
5698
92345349
BS
5699@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_FINISH_COST (void *@var{data}, unsigned *@var{prologue_cost}, unsigned *@var{body_cost}, unsigned *@var{epilogue_cost})
5700This hook should complete calculations of the cost of vectorizing a loop or basic block based on @var{data}, and return the prologue, body, and epilogue costs as unsigned integers. The default returns the value of the three accumulators.
c3e7ee41
BS
5701@end deftypefn
5702
5703@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_DESTROY_COST_DATA (void *@var{data})
5704This hook should release @var{data} and any related data structures allocated by TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST. The default releases the accumulator.
5705@end deftypefn
5706
0a35513e
AH
5707@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_TM_LOAD (tree)
5708This hook should return the built-in decl needed to load a vector of the given type within a transaction.
5709@end deftypefn
5710
5711@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_TM_STORE (tree)
5712This hook should return the built-in decl needed to store a vector of the given type within a transaction.
5713@end deftypefn
5714
aec7ae7d
JJ
5715@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_GATHER (const_tree @var{mem_vectype}, const_tree @var{index_type}, int @var{scale})
5716Target builtin that implements vector gather operation. @var{mem_vectype}
5717is the vector type of the load and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
5718the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
5719The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize gather
5720loads.
5721@end deftypefn
5722
0136f8f0
AH
5723@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_COMPUTE_VECSIZE_AND_SIMDLEN (struct cgraph_node *@var{}, struct cgraph_simd_clone *@var{}, @var{tree}, @var{int})
5724This hook should set @var{vecsize_mangle}, @var{vecsize_int}, @var{vecsize_float}
5725fields in @var{simd_clone} structure pointed by @var{clone_info} argument and also
5726@var{simdlen} field if it was previously 0.
5727The hook should return 0 if SIMD clones shouldn't be emitted,
5728or number of @var{vecsize_mangle} variants that should be emitted.
5729@end deftypefn
5730
5731@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_ADJUST (struct cgraph_node *@var{})
5732This hook should add implicit @code{attribute(target("..."))} attribute
5733to SIMD clone @var{node} if needed.
5734@end deftypefn
5735
5736@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_USABLE (struct cgraph_node *@var{})
5737This hook should return -1 if SIMD clone @var{node} shouldn't be used
5738in vectorized loops in current function, or non-negative number if it is
5739usable. In that case, the smaller the number is, the more desirable it is
5740to use it.
5741@end deftypefn
5742
aacd3885
RS
5743@node Anchored Addresses
5744@section Anchored Addresses
5745@cindex anchored addresses
5746@cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5747
5748GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5749For example, if we have:
5750
5751@smallexample
5752static int a, b, c;
5753int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5754@end smallexample
5755
5756the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5757addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5758it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5759the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5760be something like:
5761
5762@smallexample
5763int foo (void)
5764@{
5765 register int *xr = &x;
5766 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5767@}
5768@end smallexample
5769
5770(which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5771``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5772
5773The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5774in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5775section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5776or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5777
9e3be889 5778@deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
aacd3885
RS
5779The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5780On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5781applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5782for every mode. The default value is 0.
9e3be889 5783@end deftypevr
aacd3885 5784
9e3be889 5785@deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
aacd3885
RS
5786Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5787offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5788value is 0.
9e3be889 5789@end deftypevr
aacd3885
RS
5790
5791@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR (rtx @var{x})
5792Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5793@code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5794The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5795of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5796
5797If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5798it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5799If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5800is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5801@end deftypefn
5802
b6fd8800 5803@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P (const_rtx @var{x})
aacd3885 5804Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3fa9c136 5805@var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
aacd3885
RS
5806@samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5807
5808The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5809intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5810or target-specific sections.
5811@end deftypefn
5812
feca2ed3
JW
5813@node Condition Code
5814@section Condition Code Status
5815@cindex condition code status
5816
f90b7a5a
PB
5817The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5818two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5819
5820The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5821(@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5822clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5823register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5824architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5825most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5826most RISC machines.
5827
5828The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
728acca0
MP
5829the definition and use of the condition code. In the past the definition
5830and use were always adjacent. However, recent changes to support trapping
5831arithmatic may result in the definition and user being in different blocks.
5832Thus, there may be a @code{NOTE_INSN_BASIC_BLOCK} between them. Additionally,
5833the definition may be the source of exception handling edges.
5834
5835These restrictions can prevent important
f90b7a5a
PB
5836optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5837is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5838three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
5839scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5840separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5841
5842For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5843represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
5844condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
5845condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5846or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5847Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5848that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
5849
5850Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
5851specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
5852interested in most macros in this section.
5853
5854@menu
5855* CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
5856* MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
f90b7a5a
PB
5857@end menu
5858
5859@node CC0 Condition Codes
5860@subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
5861@findex cc0
feca2ed3
JW
5862
5863@findex cc_status
5864The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5865describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5866the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5867variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5868currently based, and several standard flags.
5869
5870Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5871description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5872information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5873
a2c4f8e0 5874@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
feca2ed3
JW
5875C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5876component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5877
5878This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
a2c4f8e0 5879@end defmac
feca2ed3 5880
a2c4f8e0 5881@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
feca2ed3
JW
5882A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5883The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5884the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5885define this macro to initialize it.
5886
5887This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
a2c4f8e0 5888@end defmac
feca2ed3 5889
a2c4f8e0 5890@defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
feca2ed3
JW
5891A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5892appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5893this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5894code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5895set @code{(cc0)}.
5896
5897This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5898
5899If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5900other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5901invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5902reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5903registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5904@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5905insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5906based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5907value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5908this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5909@samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5910@code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5911condition code value.
5912
5913The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5914with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5915@code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5916constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5917insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5918@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5919@code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5920
5921A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5922that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5923@samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5924two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
a2c4f8e0 5925@end defmac
feca2ed3 5926
f90b7a5a
PB
5927@node MODE_CC Condition Codes
5928@subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
5929@findex CCmode
5930@findex MODE_CC
5931
a2c4f8e0 5932@defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
f90b7a5a
PB
5933On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
5934than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
5935code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
5936when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
5937bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
5938branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
5939this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
5940record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
5941also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
5942unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
5943
5944If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
5945@file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
5946a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
5947have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
5948by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
5949be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
5950the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
5951
5952@smallexample
5953(define_insn ""
5954 [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
5955 (compare:CC_NOOV
5956 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
5957 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
5958 (const_int 0)))]
5959 ""
5960 "@dots{}")
5961@end smallexample
5962
5963@noindent
5964together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
5965for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
feca2ed3
JW
5966
5967@smallexample
5968#define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
95cc11e1
EB
5969 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
5970 ? ((OP == LT || OP == LE || OP == GT || OP == GE) \
5971 ? CCFPEmode : CCFPmode) \
5972 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
5973 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG || GET_CODE (x) == ASHIFT) \
feca2ed3
JW
5974 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
5975@end smallexample
5976
f90b7a5a
PB
5977Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
5978were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
5979this section.
5980
94134f42
ZW
5981You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
5982in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
a2c4f8e0 5983@end defmac
feca2ed3 5984
d331d374 5985@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (int *@var{code}, rtx *@var{op0}, rtx *@var{op1}, bool @var{op0_preserve_value})
8760eaae 5986On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
feca2ed3
JW
5987convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
5988does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
5989comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
5990
c354951b
AK
5991On such machines, implement this hook to do any required conversions.
5992@var{code} is the initial comparison code and @var{op0} and @var{op1}
5993are the left and right operands of the comparison, respectively. If
5994@var{op0_preserve_value} is @code{true} the implementation is not
5995allowed to change the value of @var{op0} since the value might be used
5996in RTXs which aren't comparisons. E.g. the implementation is not
5997allowed to swap operands in that case.
feca2ed3 5998
a3a15b4d 5999GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
feca2ed3
JW
6000valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
6001@file{md} file.
6002
c354951b
AK
6003You need not to implement this hook if it would never change the
6004comparison code or operands.
6005@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 6006
a2c4f8e0 6007@defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
feca2ed3
JW
6008A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
6009comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
6010can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
6011then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
6012
6013You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
6014floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
981f6289 6015For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
95cc11e1 6016inequality comparisons are given either @code{CCFPEmode} or @code{CCFPmode}:
feca2ed3
JW
6017
6018@smallexample
95cc11e1
EB
6019#define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) \
6020 ((MODE) != CCFPEmode && (MODE) != CCFPmode)
feca2ed3 6021@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 6022@end defmac
feca2ed3 6023
a2c4f8e0 6024@defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
9e7adcb3
JH
6025A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
6026comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
6027@code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
6028machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
6029instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
95cc11e1 6030freely convert unordered compares to ordered ones. Then definition may look
9e7adcb3
JH
6031like:
6032
6033@smallexample
6034#define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
c771326b 6035 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
9e7adcb3
JH
6036 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6037@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 6038@end defmac
9e7adcb3 6039
ab7e224a 6040@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS (unsigned int *@var{p1}, unsigned int *@var{p2})
e129d93a
ILT
6041On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6042register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6043regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6044hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
6045small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
6046to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6047arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6048When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
ab7e224a 6049integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
e129d93a
ILT
6050@code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6051
6052The default version of this hook returns false.
6053@end deftypefn
6054
ef4bddc2 6055@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE (machine_mode @var{m1}, machine_mode @var{m2})
e129d93a
ILT
6056On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6057@code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6058validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
6059target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6060both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
6061return @code{VOIDmode}.
6062
6063The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6064same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6065returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6066@end deftypefn
6067
8f048116
EB
6068@deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FLAGS_REGNUM
6069If the target has a dedicated flags register, and it needs to use the post-reload comparison elimination pass, then this value should be set appropriately.
6070@end deftypevr
6071
feca2ed3
JW
6072@node Costs
6073@section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6074@cindex costs of instructions
6075@cindex relative costs
6076@cindex speed of instructions
6077
6078These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6079on the target machine.
6080
a2c4f8e0 6081@defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
e56b4594
AO
6082A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6083register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6084expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6085value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6086that.
feca2ed3
JW
6087
6088It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6089same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6090registers if they are not general registers.
6091
6092If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6093hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6094classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6095constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6096allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6097if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
de8f4b07
AS
6098
6099These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6100@code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
a2c4f8e0 6101@end defmac
feca2ed3 6102
ef4bddc2 6103@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST (machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{from}, reg_class_t @var{to})
de8f4b07
AS
6104This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6105from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6106are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6107A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6108that.
6109
6110It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6111same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6112registers if they are not general registers.
6113
6114If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6115hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6116classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6117constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6118allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6119if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6120
6121The default version of this function returns 2.
6122@end deftypefn
6123
a2c4f8e0 6124@defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
cbd5b9a2
KR
6125A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6126register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
df2a54e9 6127is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
473fe49b
KR
6128is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6129registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6130should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6131
a3a15b4d 6132If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
38e01259 6133the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
473fe49b
KR
6134needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6135between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6136more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6137reflect the actual cost of the move.
6138
a3a15b4d 6139GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
473fe49b
KR
6140secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6141a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6142secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
61434 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6144value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6145are the same as to this macro.
f5c21ef3
AS
6146
6147These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6148@code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
a2c4f8e0 6149@end defmac
cbd5b9a2 6150
ef4bddc2 6151@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST (machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{rclass}, bool @var{in})
f5c21ef3 6152This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
911852ff 6153between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
f5c21ef3 6154if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
de8f4b07
AS
6155This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6156If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6157registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
f5c21ef3
AS
6158
6159If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6160the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6161needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
911852ff 6162between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
f5c21ef3
AS
6163more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6164reflect the actual cost of the move.
6165
6166GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6167secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6168a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6169secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
61704 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6171value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6172are the same as to this target hook.
6173@end deftypefn
6174
3a4fd356 6175@defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
525d13b0
MS
6176A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
6177the default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter
6178@var{speed_p} is true when the branch in question should be optimized
6179for speed. When it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should return a value
6180optimal for code size rather than performance. @var{predictable_p} is
6181true for well-predicted branches. On many architectures the
6182@code{BRANCH_COST} can be reduced then.
a2c4f8e0 6183@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
6184
6185Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
a3a15b4d 6186but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
feca2ed3
JW
6187ordinarily expect.
6188
a2c4f8e0 6189@defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
feca2ed3 6190Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
e979f9e8 6191than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
feca2ed3
JW
6192faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6193require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6194between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6195
6196When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6197finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6198load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6199faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6200may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6201other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
a2c4f8e0 6202@end defmac
feca2ed3 6203
a2c4f8e0 6204@defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
5fad8ebf
DE
6205Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6206@var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6207than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6208handler.
feca2ed3 6209
df2a54e9
JM
6210When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6211@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
feca2ed3 6212moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
df2a54e9 6213Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
feca2ed3
JW
6214cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6215
6be57663 6216If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
df2a54e9
JM
6217this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6218@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
a2c4f8e0 6219@end defmac
feca2ed3 6220
65a324b4 6221@defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
9862dea9 6222The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
c5c76735 6223which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
feca2ed3
JW
6224string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6225make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6226
c5c76735
JL
6227Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6228@code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6229the number of such sequences.
9862dea9 6230
65a324b4
NC
6231The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6232optimized for speed rather than size.
6233
feca2ed3 6234If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
a2c4f8e0 6235@end defmac
feca2ed3 6236
445d7826 6237@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BY_PIECES_INFRASTRUCTURE_P (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size}, unsigned int @var{alignment}, enum by_pieces_operation @var{op}, bool @var{speed_p})
7cbed008
JG
6238GCC will attempt several strategies when asked to copy between
6239two areas of memory, or to set, clear or store to memory, for example
6240when copying a @code{struct}. The @code{by_pieces} infrastructure
6241implements such memory operations as a sequence of load, store or move
6242insns. Alternate strategies are to expand the
6243@code{movmem} or @code{setmem} optabs, to emit a library call, or to emit
6244unit-by-unit, loop-based operations.
6245
6246This target hook should return true if, for a memory operation with a
6247given @var{size} and @var{alignment}, using the @code{by_pieces}
6248infrastructure is expected to result in better code generation.
6249Both @var{size} and @var{alignment} are measured in terms of storage
6250units.
6251
6252The parameter @var{op} is one of: @code{CLEAR_BY_PIECES},
6253@code{MOVE_BY_PIECES}, @code{SET_BY_PIECES}, @code{STORE_BY_PIECES}.
6254These describe the type of memory operation under consideration.
6255
6256The parameter @var{speed_p} is true if the code is currently being
6257optimized for speed rather than size.
6258
6259Returning true for higher values of @var{size} can improve code generation
6260for speed if the target does not provide an implementation of the
6261@code{movmem} or @code{setmem} standard names, if the @code{movmem} or
6262@code{setmem} implementation would be more expensive than a sequence of
6263insns, or if the overhead of a library call would dominate that of
6264the body of the memory operation.
6265
6266Returning true for higher values of @code{size} may also cause an increase
6267in code size, for example where the number of insns emitted to perform a
6268move would be greater than that of a library call.
6269@end deftypefn
6270
a2c4f8e0 6271@defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
fbe1758d 6272A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6e01bd94 6273a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
a2c4f8e0 6274@end defmac
fbe1758d 6275
65a324b4 6276@defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
78762e3b
RS
6277The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6278of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6279or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6280eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6281
65a324b4
NC
6282The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6283optimized for speed rather than size.
6284
78762e3b 6285If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
a2c4f8e0 6286@end defmac
78762e3b 6287
65a324b4 6288@defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
cfa31150
SL
6289The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6290of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
ff2ce160 6291a block set insn or a library call.
cfa31150
SL
6292Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6293eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6294
65a324b4
NC
6295The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6296optimized for speed rather than size.
6297
cfa31150
SL
6298If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6299@end defmac
6300
a2c4f8e0 6301@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6302A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6303thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6304@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6305@end defmac
6e01bd94 6306
a2c4f8e0 6307@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6308A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6309thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6310@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6311@end defmac
fbe1758d 6312
a2c4f8e0 6313@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6314A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6315thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6316@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6317@end defmac
6e01bd94 6318
a2c4f8e0 6319@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6320A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6321thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6322@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6323@end defmac
fbe1758d 6324
a2c4f8e0 6325@defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6326A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6327thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6328@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6329@end defmac
6e01bd94 6330
a2c4f8e0 6331@defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
c771326b 6332A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6e01bd94
MH
6333thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6334@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6335@end defmac
fbe1758d 6336
a2c4f8e0 6337@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6338This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6339thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6340@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6341@end defmac
6e01bd94 6342
a2c4f8e0 6343@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6344This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6345thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6346@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6347@end defmac
fbe1758d 6348
a2c4f8e0 6349@defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
1e8552c2 6350Define this macro to be true if it is as good or better to call a constant
feca2ed3 6351function address than to call an address kept in a register.
a2c4f8e0 6352@end defmac
feca2ed3 6353
a8d56c30
SB
6354@defmac LOGICAL_OP_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6355Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6356@samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6357@code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6358@end defmac
6359
e548c9df 6360@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RTX_COSTS (rtx @var{x}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{outer_code}, int @var{opno}, int *@var{total}, bool @var{speed})
3c50106f
RH
6361This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6362
6363The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
68f932c4
RS
6364available for examination in @var{x}, and the fact that @var{x} appears
6365as operand @var{opno} of an expression with rtx code @var{outer_code}.
6366That is, the hook can assume that there is some rtx @var{y} such
6367that @samp{GET_CODE (@var{y}) == @var{outer_code}} and such that
6368either (a) @samp{XEXP (@var{y}, @var{opno}) == @var{x}} or
6369(b) @samp{XVEC (@var{y}, @var{opno})} contains @var{x}.
6370
e548c9df
AM
6371@var{mode} is @var{x}'s machine mode, or for cases like @code{const_int} that
6372do not have a mode, the mode in which @var{x} is used.
3c50106f
RH
6373
6374In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6375@code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6376instructions.
6377
6378On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6379for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
31a52b86
RS
6380necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6381for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6382operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6383
65a324b4
NC
6384When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6385false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
31a52b86 6386size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
3c50106f
RH
6387
6388The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6389processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6390@end deftypefn
6391
ef4bddc2 6392@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDRESS_COST (rtx @var{address}, machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as}, bool @var{speed})
10154ff8
RH
6393This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6394@var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6395the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6396
6397For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6398true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6399instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6400all addresses will have equal costs.
6401
6402In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6403the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6404cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6405
6406For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6407and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6408is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6409references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6410the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6411that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6412instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6413specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6414
6415This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6416
6417On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6418cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6419@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6420be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6421@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6422should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6423should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6424registers on machines with lots of registers.
6425@end deftypefn
6426
c237e94a
ZW
6427@node Scheduling
6428@section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6429
6430The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6431adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6432hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6433them: try the first ones in this list first.
6434
6435@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE (void)
fae15c93
VM
6436This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6437issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6438Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6439an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6440constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6441hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6442This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6443it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
c237e94a
ZW
6444@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6445@end deftypefn
6446
ac44248e 6447@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{more})
c237e94a
ZW
6448This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6449from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
3ee04299
DE
6450still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6451@samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6452@code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6453You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6454than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6455@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6456debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6457@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6458was scheduled.
c237e94a
ZW
6459@end deftypefn
6460
ac44248e 6461@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx @var{link}, rtx_insn *@var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost})
fae15c93
VM
6462This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6463relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
6464dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
6465is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
6466to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
c237e94a 6467that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
fae15c93
VM
6468data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6469description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6470output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6471times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6472acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
fa0aee89 6473@pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
c237e94a
ZW
6474@end deftypefn
6475
ac44248e 6476@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{priority})
c237e94a 6477This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
496d7bb0
MK
6478@var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6479execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
c237e94a
ZW
6480later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6481scheduling priorities of insns.
6482@end deftypefn
6483
ce1ce33a 6484@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn **@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
c237e94a
ZW
6485This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6486list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6487combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6488@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6489debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6490@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6491list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6492a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6493reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
65a324b4 6494@var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
c237e94a
ZW
6495is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6496the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6497can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6498@samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6499@end deftypefn
6500
ce1ce33a 6501@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn **@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
c237e94a
ZW
6502Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6503function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6504is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6505@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6506return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6507this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6508scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6509cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6510@end deftypefn
6511
0dc41f28
WM
6512@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_MACRO_FUSION_P (void)
6513This hook is used to check whether target platform supports macro fusion.
6514@end deftypefn
6515
892d9879
KT
6516@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_MACRO_FUSION_PAIR_P (rtx_insn *@var{prev}, rtx_insn *@var{curr})
6517This hook is used to check whether two insns should be macro fused for
6518a target microarchitecture. If this hook returns true for the given insn pair
6519(@var{prev} and @var{curr}), the scheduler will put them into a sched
6520group, and they will not be scheduled apart. The two insns will be either
6521two SET insns or a compare and a conditional jump and this hook should
6522validate any dependencies needed to fuse the two insns together.
0dc41f28
WM
6523@end deftypefn
6524
ce1ce33a 6525@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK (rtx_insn *@var{head}, rtx_insn *@var{tail})
30028c85
VM
6526This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6527chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6528correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6529example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6530analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6531dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6532calculated.
6533@end deftypefn
6534
c237e94a
ZW
6535@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{max_ready})
6536This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6537instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6538pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6539is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6540@var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6541region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
431ae0bf 6542scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
c237e94a
ZW
6543@end deftypefn
6544
6545@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6546This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6547instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6548cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6549is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6550to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6551@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6552@end deftypefn
6553
58565a33
SKG
6554@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{old_max_uid})
6555This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6556@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6557@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6558@var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6559@end deftypefn
6560
6561@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
8a36672b 6562This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
58565a33
SKG
6563@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6564@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6565@end deftypefn
6566
914d25dc 6567@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
fae15c93
VM
6568The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6569pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6570when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6571simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6572processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6573based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6574when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6575@end deftypefn
6576
6577@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6578The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6579@end deftypefn
6580
ac44248e 6581@deftypefn {Target Hook} {rtx_insn *} TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
fae15c93
VM
6582The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6583to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6584simulated processor cycle finishes.
6585@end deftypefn
6586
6587@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6588The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6589used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6590@end deftypefn
6591
914d25dc 6592@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
1c3d0d93
MK
6593The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6594The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
021efafc 6595to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
1c3d0d93
MK
6596state on a single insn is not enough.
6597@end deftypefn
6598
914d25dc 6599@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
1c3d0d93
MK
6600The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6601The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
021efafc 6602to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
1c3d0d93
MK
6603state on a single insn is not enough.
6604@end deftypefn
6605
fae15c93
VM
6606@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD (void)
6607This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6608for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6609chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6610value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6611@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6612subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6613maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6614@acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6615packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6616rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6617
6618This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6619processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6620with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6621@var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6622@var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6623processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6624@var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6625until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6626the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6627
6628Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6629pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6630schedules to choose the best one.
6631
6632The default is no multipass scheduling.
6633@end deftypefn
6634
ac44248e 6635@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{ready_index})
30028c85
VM
6636
6637This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6638considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
4960a0cb
MK
6639zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be considered in multipass scheduling.
6640Positive return values will remove @var{insn} from consideration on
6641the current round of multipass scheduling.
6642Negative return values will remove @var{insn} from consideration for given
6643number of cycles.
6644Backends should be careful about returning non-zero for highest priority
6645instruction at position 0 in the ready list. @var{ready_index} is passed
6646to allow backends make correct judgements.
30028c85 6647
62b9c42c 6648The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
30028c85
VM
6649@end deftypefn
6650
4960a0cb 6651@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN (void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, bool @var{first_cycle_insn_p})
894fd6f2
MK
6652This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
6653scheduling.
6654@end deftypefn
6655
ac44248e 6656@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE (void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, const void *@var{prev_data})
894fd6f2
MK
6657This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
6658@end deftypefn
6659
4960a0cb 6660@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK (const void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready})
894fd6f2
MK
6661This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
6662an instruction.
6663@end deftypefn
6664
6665@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END (const void *@var{data})
6666This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
6667round of multipass scheduling.
6668@end deftypefn
6669
6670@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT (void *@var{data})
2b0d3573 6671This hook initializes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
894fd6f2
MK
6672@end deftypefn
6673
6674@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI (void *@var{data})
2b0d3573 6675This hook finalizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
894fd6f2
MK
6676@end deftypefn
6677
ac44248e 6678@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE (FILE *@var{dump}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{last_clock}, int @var{clock}, int *@var{sort_p})
a934eb2d
JR
6679This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6680on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6681@var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6682the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6683is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6684start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6685verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6686@var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6687processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6688and the current processor cycle.
30028c85
VM
6689@end deftypefn
6690
72392b81 6691@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE (struct _dep *@var{_dep}, int @var{cost}, int @var{distance})
569fa502 6692This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
daf2f129 6693the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
569fa502 6694are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
b198261f
MK
6695to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6696being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
72392b81 6697dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
daf2f129 6698parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
569fa502
DN
6699The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6700insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6701and @code{false} otherwise.
6702
6703Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
daf2f129 6704where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
569fa502 6705delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
daf2f129 6706that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
569fa502 6707important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
78466c0e 6708closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
72392b81 6709not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
569fa502
DN
6710@end deftypefn
6711
496d7bb0
MK
6712@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED (void)
6713This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6714the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6715per instruction data structures.
6716@end deftypefn
6717
b6fd8800 6718@deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT (void)
e855c69d
AB
6719Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6720@end deftypefn
6721
6722@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc}, bool @var{clean_p})
6723Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6724It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
ab7e224a 6725beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
e855c69d
AB
6726@end deftypefn
6727
6728@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
914d25dc 6729Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
e855c69d
AB
6730@end deftypefn
6731
6732@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6733Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6734@end deftypefn
6735
6736@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6737Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6738@end deftypefn
6739
ac44248e 6740@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, unsigned int @var{dep_status}, rtx *@var{new_pat})
64ee9490
EC
6741This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6742speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6743The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6744version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6745pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
8ad1dde7 6746or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
496d7bb0
MK
6747speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6748the generated speculative pattern.
6749@end deftypefn
6750
8e90de43 6751@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P (unsigned int @var{dep_status})
496d7bb0 6752This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
72392b81
JR
6753for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6754instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
496d7bb0
MK
6755@end deftypefn
6756
ac44248e 6757@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx_insn *@var{label}, unsigned int @var{ds})
496d7bb0 6758This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
64ee9490
EC
6759check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6760speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6761@var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6762be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6763recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6764a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
496d7bb0
MK
6765@var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6766@end deftypefn
6767
50e87e30 6768@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS (struct spec_info_def *@var{spec_info})
64ee9490 6769This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
50e87e30
JR
6770enabled/used.
6771The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
496d7bb0
MK
6772The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6773@end deftypefn
6774
67186a97
TS
6775@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII (struct ddg *@var{g})
6776This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6777resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6778the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
6779backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
6780bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6781of instructions divided by the issue rate.
6782@end deftypefn
6783
ac44248e 6784@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{x})
7942e47e
RY
6785This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
6786is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
6787@end deftypefn
6788
ac44248e 6789@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{x})
7942e47e
RY
6790This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
6791in its second parameter.
6792@end deftypefn
6793
b0bd15f7
BS
6794@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_EXPOSED_PIPELINE
6795True if the processor has an exposed pipeline, which means that not just
6796the order of instructions is important for correctness when scheduling, but
6797also the latencies of operations.
6798@end deftypevr
6799
ef4bddc2 6800@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REASSOCIATION_WIDTH (unsigned int @var{opc}, machine_mode @var{mode})
df7b0cc4
EI
6801This hook is called by tree reassociator to determine a level of
6802parallelism required in output calculations chain.
6803@end deftypefn
6804
b16abbcb
BC
6805@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FUSION_PRIORITY (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{max_pri}, int *@var{fusion_pri}, int *@var{pri})
6806This hook is called by scheduling fusion pass. It calculates fusion
6807priorities for each instruction passed in by parameter. The priorities
6808are returned via pointer parameters.
6809
6810@var{insn} is the instruction whose priorities need to be calculated.
6811@var{max_pri} is the maximum priority can be returned in any cases.
6812@var{fusion_pri} is the pointer parameter through which @var{insn}'s
6813fusion priority should be calculated and returned.
6814@var{pri} is the pointer parameter through which @var{insn}'s priority
6815should be calculated and returned.
6816
6817Same @var{fusion_pri} should be returned for instructions which should
6818be scheduled together. Different @var{pri} should be returned for
6819instructions with same @var{fusion_pri}. @var{fusion_pri} is the major
6820sort key, @var{pri} is the minor sort key. All instructions will be
6821scheduled according to the two priorities. All priorities calculated
6822should be between 0 (exclusive) and @var{max_pri} (inclusive). To avoid
6823false dependencies, @var{fusion_pri} of instructions which need to be
6824scheduled together should be smaller than @var{fusion_pri} of irrelevant
6825instructions.
6826
6827Given below example:
6828
51be4977 6829@smallexample
b16abbcb
BC
6830 ldr r10, [r1, 4]
6831 add r4, r4, r10
6832 ldr r15, [r2, 8]
6833 sub r5, r5, r15
6834 ldr r11, [r1, 0]
6835 add r4, r4, r11
6836 ldr r16, [r2, 12]
6837 sub r5, r5, r16
51be4977 6838@end smallexample
b16abbcb
BC
6839
6840On targets like ARM/AArch64, the two pairs of consecutive loads should be
6841merged. Since peephole2 pass can't help in this case unless consecutive
6842loads are actually next to each other in instruction flow. That's where
6843this scheduling fusion pass works. This hook calculates priority for each
6844instruction based on its fustion type, like:
6845
51be4977
BC
6846@smallexample
6847 ldr r10, [r1, 4] ; fusion_pri=99, pri=96
6848 add r4, r4, r10 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
6849 ldr r15, [r2, 8] ; fusion_pri=98, pri=92
6850 sub r5, r5, r15 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
6851 ldr r11, [r1, 0] ; fusion_pri=99, pri=100
6852 add r4, r4, r11 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
6853 ldr r16, [r2, 12] ; fusion_pri=98, pri=88
6854 sub r5, r5, r16 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
6855@end smallexample
b16abbcb
BC
6856
6857Scheduling fusion pass then sorts all ready to issue instructions according
6858to the priorities. As a result, instructions of same fusion type will be
6859pushed together in instruction flow, like:
6860
51be4977 6861@smallexample
b16abbcb
BC
6862 ldr r11, [r1, 0]
6863 ldr r10, [r1, 4]
6864 ldr r15, [r2, 8]
6865 ldr r16, [r2, 12]
6866 add r4, r4, r10
6867 sub r5, r5, r15
6868 add r4, r4, r11
6869 sub r5, r5, r16
51be4977 6870@end smallexample
b16abbcb
BC
6871
6872Now peephole2 pass can simply merge the two pairs of loads.
6873
6874Since scheduling fusion pass relies on peephole2 to do real fusion
6875work, it is only enabled by default when peephole2 is in effect.
6876
6877This is firstly introduced on ARM/AArch64 targets, please refer to
6878the hook implementation for how different fusion types are supported.
6879@end deftypefn
6880
feca2ed3
JW
6881@node Sections
6882@section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6883@c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
6884@c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
6885
6886An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6887data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
6888section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
6889section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
6890section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
6891of sections.
6892
d6b5193b
RS
6893@file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
6894@code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
6895The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
6896is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
6897as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
6898initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
6899They may however depend on command-line flags.
6900
6901@emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
6902use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
6903to be string literals.
6904
6905Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
6906section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
6907should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
6908@code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
6909
6910You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
6911@code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
6912in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
6913@code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
6914create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
6915reuse @code{text_section}.
6916
6917All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
6918if the target does not provide them.
feca2ed3 6919
a2c4f8e0 6920@defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
047c1c92
HPN
6921A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6922assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
6923Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
a2c4f8e0 6924@end defmac
33c09f2f 6925
a2c4f8e0 6926@defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
194734e9
JH
6927If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
6928frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
6929a default definition if the target supports named sections.
a2c4f8e0 6930@end defmac
194734e9 6931
a2c4f8e0 6932@defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
194734e9
JH
6933If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
6934executed functions in the program.
a2c4f8e0 6935@end defmac
194734e9 6936
a2c4f8e0 6937@defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
047c1c92
HPN
6938A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6939assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
6940data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
a2c4f8e0 6941@end defmac
feca2ed3 6942
d6b5193b
RS
6943@defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6944If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6945containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6946initialized, writable small data.
6947@end defmac
6948
a2c4f8e0 6949@defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
d48bc59a
RH
6950A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6951assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
6952data.
a2c4f8e0 6953@end defmac
d48bc59a 6954
a2c4f8e0 6955@defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
047c1c92
HPN
6956If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6957containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
ddf72388 6958uninitialized global data. If not defined, and
07c5f94e 6959@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} not defined,
047c1c92 6960uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
630d3d5a 6961@option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
047c1c92 6962used.
a2c4f8e0 6963@end defmac
feca2ed3 6964
d6b5193b
RS
6965@defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6966If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6967containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6968uninitialized, writable small data.
6969@end defmac
6970
9b7e6950
RO
6971@defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
6972If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
6973assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
6974common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
6975@end defmac
6976
6977@defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
6978If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
6979containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
6980default is @code{'T'}.
6981@end defmac
6982
a2c4f8e0 6983@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
047c1c92
HPN
6984If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6985containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6986initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
98bfa2fb
RS
6987not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
6988variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
a2c4f8e0 6989@end defmac
feca2ed3 6990
a2c4f8e0 6991@defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
047c1c92
HPN
6992If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6993containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6994finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
98bfa2fb
RS
6995not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
6996variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
a2c4f8e0 6997@end defmac
750054a2 6998
7abc66b1
JB
6999@defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
7000If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7001containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7002part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
7003defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
7004both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
7005@end defmac
083cad55 7006
7abc66b1
JB
7007@defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
7008If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7009containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7010part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
7011defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
7012both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
7013@end defmac
7014
a2c4f8e0 7015@defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
cea3bd3e
RH
7016If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
7017via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
7018the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
7019@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
7020to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
7021sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
1b2dd04a
AO
7022ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
7023registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
7024constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
a2c4f8e0 7025@end defmac
1b2dd04a 7026
a0cfeb0f
DD
7027@defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
7028If defined, a string which names the section into which small
7029variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
7030when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
7031you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
7032they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
7033expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
7034MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
7035require small data support from your application, but use this macro
7036to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
7037access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
726e9992 7038@end defmac
a0cfeb0f 7039
a2c4f8e0 7040@defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
cea3bd3e
RH
7041If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
7042arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
7043@code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
7044and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
a2c4f8e0 7045@end defmac
cea3bd3e 7046
a2c4f8e0 7047@defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
df2a54e9 7048Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
75197b37
BS
7049tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
7050section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
7051readonly data section is used.
feca2ed3
JW
7052
7053This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
a2c4f8e0 7054@end defmac
feca2ed3 7055
d6b5193b
RS
7056@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS (void)
7057Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
7058@file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
7059of its own that you need to create.
7060
7061GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
7062any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
7063described below.
7064@end deftypefn
7065
914d25dc 7066@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK (void)
9b580a0b
RH
7067Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
7068selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
7069should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
7070local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
7071
7072The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
7073is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
7074when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
7075in read-only sections even in executables.
7076@end deftypefn
7077
d6b5193b
RS
7078@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION (tree @var{exp}, int @var{reloc}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7079Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
ae46c4e0
RH
7080assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
7081some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
7082requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
7083local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
d6b5193b 7084@var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
ae46c4e0
RH
7085
7086The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
7087variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
09afda70
GK
7088
7089See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
ae46c4e0
RH
7090@end deftypefn
7091
09afda70
GK
7092@defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
7093Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
7094for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
7095
7096In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
7097function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
7098it is unlikely to be called.
7099@end defmac
7100
ae46c4e0
RH
7101@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, int @var{reloc})
7102Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
7103and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7104As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
7105the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
7106
7107The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
7108ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
7109example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
7110Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
7111@end deftypefn
7112
d6b5193b
RS
7113@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION (tree @var{decl})
7114Return the readonly data section associated with
ab5c8549 7115@samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
d6b5193b
RS
7116The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7117the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7118if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7119otherwise.
ab5c8549
JJ
7120@end deftypefn
7121
727a65e6
BS
7122@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_MERGEABLE_RODATA_PREFIX
7123Usually, the compiler uses the prefix @code{".rodata"} to construct
7124section names for mergeable constant data. Define this macro to override
7125the string if a different section name should be used.
7126@end deftypevr
7127
50b0b78a
IS
7128@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_TM_CLONE_TABLE_SECTION (void)
7129Return the section that should be used for transactional memory clone tables.
7130@end deftypefn
7131
ef4bddc2 7132@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
d6b5193b
RS
7133Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7134should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
b64a1b53 7135constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
d6b5193b
RS
7136case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
7137in bits.
b64a1b53
RH
7138
7139The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7140constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7141else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7142@end deftypefn
7143
914d25dc 7144@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{id})
5234b8f5
DS
7145Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7146by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7147the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7148or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
7149hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7150your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
7151returns the @var{id} provided.
7152@end deftypefn
7153
c6a2438a 7154@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (tree @var{decl}, rtx @var{rtl}, int @var{new_decl_p})
fb49053f
RH
7155Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7156treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7157function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7158
c6a2438a
ZW
7159The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7160@var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7161an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7162rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
0864034e 7163in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
c6a2438a
ZW
7164
7165In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7166a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7167will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7168register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7169rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7170leave it alone.)
fb49053f
RH
7171
7172The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
c6a2438a 7173that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
fb49053f
RH
7174be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7175declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7176declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
c6a2438a 7177@var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
fb49053f
RH
7178
7179@cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
c6a2438a
ZW
7180The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7181@code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7182Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7183encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7184discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7185
7186The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7187in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7188@code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7189before overriding it.
fb49053f
RH
7190@end deftypefn
7191
914d25dc 7192@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (const char *@var{name})
772c5265
RH
7193Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7194the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7195may have added.
7196@end deftypefn
7197
b6fd8800 7198@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P (const_tree @var{exp})
47754fd5
RH
7199Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7200The default version of this hook always returns false.
7201@end deftypefn
7202
9e3be889 7203@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
e2a6476e
DE
7204Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7205``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
9e3be889 7206@end deftypevr
e2a6476e 7207
3c5273a9
KT
7208@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE (void)
7209It returns true if target wants profile code emitted before prologue.
7210
7211The default version of this hook use the target macro
7212@code{PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE}.
7213@end deftypefn
7214
b6fd8800 7215@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P (const_tree @var{exp})
47754fd5
RH
7216Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7217rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7218or executable image).
7219
7220The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7221for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7222currently supported object file formats.
7223@end deftypefn
7224
9e3be889 7225@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_TLS
e2a6476e
DE
7226Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7227The default value is false.
9e3be889 7228@end deftypevr
e2a6476e
DE
7229
7230
feca2ed3
JW
7231@node PIC
7232@section Position Independent Code
7233@cindex position independent code
7234@cindex PIC
7235
7236This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7237independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
c6c3dba9
PB
7238generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7239@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7240@code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7241must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7242when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7243need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7244relative addresses.
ff2ce160 7245@c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
feca2ed3
JW
7246@c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7247
a2c4f8e0 7248@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
7249The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7250data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
161d7b59 7251processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
feca2ed3
JW
7252is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7253pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7254is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
003b9f78 7255necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
12beba6f 7256when @code{flag_pic} is true).
a2c4f8e0 7257@end defmac
feca2ed3 7258
a2c4f8e0 7259@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
f8fe0a4a
JM
7260A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7261@code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7262the default is zero. Do not define
ed4db1ee 7263this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
a2c4f8e0 7264@end defmac
feca2ed3 7265
a2c4f8e0 7266@defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
feca2ed3
JW
7267A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7268operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7269You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7270check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7271check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7272(including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7273position independent code.
a2c4f8e0 7274@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
7275
7276@node Assembler Format
7277@section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7278
7279This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
648c546a 7280to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
feca2ed3
JW
7281instructions do.
7282
7283@menu
7284* File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7285* Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7286* Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7287* Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7288* Initialization:: General principles of initialization
6ccde948 7289 and termination routines.
feca2ed3 7290* Macros for Initialization::
6ccde948
RW
7291 Specific macros that control the handling of
7292 initialization and termination routines.
feca2ed3
JW
7293* Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7294* Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7295* Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7296* Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7297@end menu
7298
7299@node File Framework
7300@subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7301@cindex assembler format
7302@cindex output of assembler code
7303
7304@c prevent bad page break with this line
1bc7c5b6
ZW
7305This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7306
1bc7c5b6 7307@findex default_file_start
914d25dc 7308@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_START (void)
1bc7c5b6
ZW
7309Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7310find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7311by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7312quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7313@code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7314lets other target files rely on these variables.
7315@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 7316
1bc7c5b6
ZW
7317@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7318If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7319printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7320@option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7321to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7322definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7323assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7324whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7325
7326The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7327verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7328comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7329@end deftypevr
7330
7331@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7332If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7333for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7334@code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7335this to be done. The default is false.
7336@end deftypevr
feca2ed3 7337
b6fd8800 7338@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_END (void)
a5fe455b
ZW
7339Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7340to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7341@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 7342
a5fe455b
ZW
7343@deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7344Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7345special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7346the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7347should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7348need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7349this function.
7350@end deftypefun
feca2ed3 7351
c082f9f3
SB
7352@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_START (void)
7353Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7354to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7355nothing.
7356@end deftypefn
7357
7358@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_END (void)
7359Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7360to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7361nothing.
7362@end deftypefn
7363
6d217c32
JJ
7364@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CODE_END (void)
7365Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7366unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7367here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7368because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7369nothing.
7370@end deftypefn
7371
a2c4f8e0 7372@defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
feca2ed3
JW
7373A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7374assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7375the end of the line.
a2c4f8e0 7376@end defmac
feca2ed3 7377
a2c4f8e0 7378@defmac ASM_APP_ON
feca2ed3
JW
7379A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7380statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7381@code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7382assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7383that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
a2c4f8e0 7384@end defmac
feca2ed3 7385
a2c4f8e0 7386@defmac ASM_APP_OFF
feca2ed3
JW
7387A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7388statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7389@code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7390time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
a2c4f8e0 7391@end defmac
feca2ed3 7392
a2c4f8e0 7393@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
feca2ed3
JW
7394A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7395which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7396the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7397
7398This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7399for the file format in use is appropriate.
a2c4f8e0 7400@end defmac
feca2ed3 7401
b5f5d41d
AS
7402@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name})
7403Output COFF information or DWARF debugging information which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to the stdio stream @var{file}.
edeab219 7404
b5f5d41d
AS
7405 This target hook need not be defined if the standard form of output for the file format in use is appropriate.
7406@end deftypefn
7407
a8781821
SB
7408@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (const char *@var{name})
7409Output a string based on @var{name}, suitable for the @samp{#ident} directive, or the equivalent directive or pragma in non-C-family languages. If this hook is not defined, nothing is output for the @samp{#ident} directive.
7410@end deftypefn
7411
a2c4f8e0 7412@defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
e9a25f70
JL
7413A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7414@var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
a3a15b4d 7415in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
e9a25f70
JL
7416the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7417of the filename using this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7418@end defmac
e9a25f70 7419
914d25dc 7420@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION (const char *@var{name}, unsigned int @var{flags}, tree @var{decl})
7c262518
RH
7421Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7422should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
914d25dc
JR
7423of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7424is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7425this section is associated.
7c262518
RH
7426@end deftypefn
7427
f16d3f39
JH
7428@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, enum node_frequency @var{freq}, bool @var{startup}, bool @var{exit})
7429Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.
7430Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
ff2ce160 7431functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only
f16d3f39
JH
7432at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).
7433@var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit
7434(from static destructors).
7435Return NULL if function should go to default text section.
7436@end deftypefn
7437
14d11d40
IS
7438@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SWITCHED_TEXT_SECTIONS (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{decl}, bool @var{new_is_cold})
7439Used by the target to emit any assembler directives or additional labels needed when a function is partitioned between different sections. Output should be written to @var{file}. The function decl is available as @var{decl} and the new section is `cold' if @var{new_is_cold} is @code{true}.
7440@end deftypefn
7441
677f3fa8 7442@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7c262518 7443This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
d5fabb58 7444It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
914d25dc 7445@end deftypevr
7c262518 7446
434aeebb 7447@anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
914d25dc 7448@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
434aeebb
RS
7449This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7450section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7451This is true on most ELF targets.
914d25dc 7452@end deftypevr
434aeebb 7453
7c262518
RH
7454@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{name}, int @var{reloc})
7455Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7456based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7457declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
6ccde948 7458null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7c262518 7459
224504d2 7460The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7c262518
RH
7461read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7462need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7463set via @code{__attribute__}.
7464@end deftypefn
7465
b6fd8800 7466@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES (print_switch_type @var{type}, const char *@var{text})
e0d9d0dd
NC
7467Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7468switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7469enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7470It can take the following values:
7471
7472@table @gcctabopt
7473@item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7474@var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7475
7476@item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7477@var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7478direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7479default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7480command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7481various different individual optimization passes.
7482
7483@item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7484@var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7485ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7486target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7487time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7488warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7489wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7490necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7491perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7492switches.
7493
7494@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7495This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7496
7497@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7498This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7499@end table
7500
7501The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7502supported in the future.
7503
7504By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7505provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7506it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7507section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7508provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7509hook.
7510@end deftypefn
7511
914d25dc 7512@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
e0d9d0dd
NC
7513This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7514ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7515hook.
914d25dc 7516@end deftypevr
e0d9d0dd 7517
feca2ed3
JW
7518@need 2000
7519@node Data Output
7520@subsection Output of Data
7521
301d03af
RS
7522
7523@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7524@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7525@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7526@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7527@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7528@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7529@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7530@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7531@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7532These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7533of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7534byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7535aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7536@code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7537
7538The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7539followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7540the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7541@end deftypevr
7542
7543@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_INTEGER (rtx @var{x}, unsigned int @var{size}, int @var{aligned_p})
7544The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7545integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7546in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7547function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7548object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7549split the object into smaller parts.
7550
7551The default implementation of this hook will use the
7552@code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7553when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7554@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 7555
dc2af904
BS
7556@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECL_END (void)
7557Define this hook if the target assembler requires a special marker to
7558terminate an initialized variable declaration.
7559@end deftypefn
7560
6cbd8875
AS
7561@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{x})
7562A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7563can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7564the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7565@code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7566
7567If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7568so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7569itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7570return @code{true}.
7571@end deftypefn
7572
a2c4f8e0 7573@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
feca2ed3
JW
7574A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7575instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7576bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7577@code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7578
7579If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7580Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7581@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
a2c4f8e0 7582@end defmac
feca2ed3 7583
a2c4f8e0 7584@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
67231816
RH
7585A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7586@var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7587is defined, and is otherwise unused.
a2c4f8e0 7588@end defmac
67231816 7589
a2c4f8e0 7590@defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
861bb6c1 7591You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
df2a54e9 7592expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
861bb6c1 7593pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
a3a15b4d
JL
7594GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7595not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
861bb6c1 7596pool before the function.
a2c4f8e0 7597@end defmac
861bb6c1 7598
a2c4f8e0 7599@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
feca2ed3
JW
7600A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7601constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7602the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7603be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7604is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7605immediately after this call.
7606
7607If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7608not be defined.
a2c4f8e0 7609@end defmac
feca2ed3 7610
a2c4f8e0 7611@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
feca2ed3
JW
7612A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7613constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7614anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7615
7616The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7617assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7618output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7619@samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7620@var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7621alignment.
7622
7623The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7624the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7625responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7626Here is how to do this:
7627
3ab51846 7628@smallexample
4977bab6 7629@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
3ab51846 7630@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
7631
7632When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7633@code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7634entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7635
7636You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
a2c4f8e0 7637@end defmac
feca2ed3 7638
a2c4f8e0 7639@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
861bb6c1
JL
7640A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7641pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7642function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7643obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
a3a15b4d 7644constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
861bb6c1
JL
7645
7646If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7647define this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7648@end defmac
861bb6c1 7649
980d8882 7650@defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
feca2ed3 7651Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
980d8882
BS
7652used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7653to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7654a line separator uses multiple characters.
feca2ed3
JW
7655
7656If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7657the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
a2c4f8e0 7658@end defmac
feca2ed3 7659
8ca83838 7660@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
baed53ac 7661@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
17b53c33
NB
7662These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7663assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7664default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
8ca83838 7665@end deftypevr
17b53c33 7666
6ccde948 7667These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
feca2ed3
JW
7668of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7669
a2c4f8e0
ZW
7670@defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7671@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7672@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
dadb213f
BE
7673@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7674@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7675@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7676These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7677target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7678the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7679@code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7680simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7681@code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7682by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7683it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
768432 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7685on the host machine.
feca2ed3
JW
7686
7687The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7688using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7689machine's memory.
a2c4f8e0 7690@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
7691
7692@node Uninitialized Data
7693@subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7694
7695Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7696outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7697
a2c4f8e0 7698@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
feca2ed3
JW
7699A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7700@var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7701@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
233215fe
DK
7702is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7703possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7704other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7705backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7706byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7707equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7708the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7709an ordinary undefined external.
feca2ed3
JW
7710
7711Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7712output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7713assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7714
7715This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7716common global variables are output.
a2c4f8e0 7717@end defmac
feca2ed3 7718
a2c4f8e0 7719@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
feca2ed3
JW
7720Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7721separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7722place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7723handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7724as the number of bits.
a2c4f8e0 7725@end defmac
feca2ed3 7726
a2c4f8e0 7727@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
e9a25f70
JL
7728Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7729variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
8760eaae 7730is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
e9a25f70
JL
7731in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7732@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
7733the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
a2c4f8e0 7734@end defmac
e9a25f70 7735
07c5f94e 7736@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
feca2ed3
JW
7737A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7738@var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
07c5f94e
AS
7739@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{alignment}
7740is the alignment specified as the number of bits.
feca2ed3 7741
07c5f94e
AS
7742Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7743@file{varasm.c} when defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
feca2ed3
JW
7744@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7745before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7746the name, and a newline.
7747
07c5f94e 7748There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define this macro.
434aeebb
RS
7749The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7750switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7751You do not need to do both.
7752
7753Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7754non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7755efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
7756not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7757common in order to save space in the object file.
a2c4f8e0 7758@end defmac
feca2ed3 7759
a2c4f8e0 7760@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
feca2ed3
JW
7761A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7762@var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7763@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7764is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7765
7766Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7767output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7768assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7769
7770This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7771static variables are output.
a2c4f8e0 7772@end defmac
feca2ed3 7773
a2c4f8e0 7774@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
feca2ed3
JW
7775Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
7776separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7777place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
7778handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7779as the number of bits.
a2c4f8e0 7780@end defmac
feca2ed3 7781
a2c4f8e0 7782@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
e9a25f70
JL
7783Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
7784variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
8760eaae 7785is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
e9a25f70
JL
7786in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
7787@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
7788the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
a2c4f8e0 7789@end defmac
e9a25f70 7790
feca2ed3
JW
7791@node Label Output
7792@subsection Output and Generation of Labels
7793
7794@c prevent bad page break with this line
7795This is about outputting labels.
7796
feca2ed3 7797@findex assemble_name
a2c4f8e0 7798@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
feca2ed3
JW
7799A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7800@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
7801Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7802output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
4ad5e05d
KG
7803assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7804definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
a2c4f8e0 7805@end defmac
feca2ed3 7806
135a687e
KT
7807@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7808A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7809@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
7810a function.
7811Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7812output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7813assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7814definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7815
7816If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7817usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7818@end defmac
7819
57829bc4
MM
7820@findex assemble_name_raw
7821@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
e374d5c9 7822Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
57829bc4
MM
7823to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
7824@code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
7825that it is more efficient.
7826@end defmac
7827
a2c4f8e0 7828@defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
2be2ac70
ZW
7829A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7830size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7831default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
7832systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7833
7834Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
7835of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
7836for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
7837macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
7838define this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7839@end defmac
2be2ac70 7840
a2c4f8e0 7841@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
2be2ac70
ZW
7842A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7843@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
7844symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
7845If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7846provided.
a2c4f8e0 7847@end defmac
2be2ac70 7848
a2c4f8e0 7849@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
2be2ac70
ZW
7850A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7851@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
99086d59 7852the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
73774972 7853address.
99086d59
ZW
7854
7855If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7856provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
7857@samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
7858the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
7859not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
7860to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
a2c4f8e0 7861@end defmac
2be2ac70 7862
e537ef59
GP
7863@defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
7864Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
7865@samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
7866G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
7867@samp{.} is used instead.
7868@end defmac
7869
7870@defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
7871Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
7872@samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
7873have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
7874are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
7875@end defmac
7876
a2c4f8e0 7877@defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
2be2ac70
ZW
7878A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7879type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7880default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
7881systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7882
7883Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7884@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7885custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7886types at all, do not define this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7887@end defmac
2be2ac70 7888
a2c4f8e0 7889@defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
2be2ac70
ZW
7890A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
7891the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
7892default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
7893the default is not to define this macro.
7894
7895Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7896@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7897custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7898types at all, do not define this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7899@end defmac
2be2ac70 7900
a2c4f8e0 7901@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
2be2ac70
ZW
7902A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7903@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
7904symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
7905that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
7906you should not count on this.
7907
7908If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
7909definition of this macro is provided.
a2c4f8e0 7910@end defmac
2be2ac70 7911
a2c4f8e0 7912@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
feca2ed3
JW
7913A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7914@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7915function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
7916outputting the label definition (perhaps using
135a687e 7917@code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
feca2ed3
JW
7918@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7919
7920If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
135a687e 7921usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
feca2ed3 7922
2be2ac70
ZW
7923You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
7924of this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7925@end defmac
2be2ac70 7926
a2c4f8e0 7927@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
feca2ed3
JW
7928A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7929@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
7930which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
7931function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
7932representing the function.
7933
7934If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
7935
2be2ac70
ZW
7936You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
7937of this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7938@end defmac
2be2ac70 7939
81ccb752
CT
7940@defmac ASM_DECLARE_COLD_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7941A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7942@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7943cold function partition which is being defined. This macro is responsible
7944for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7945@code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
7946@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7947
7948If this macro is not defined, then the cold partition name is defined in the
7949usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7950
7951You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
7952of this macro.
7953@end defmac
7954
7955@defmac ASM_DECLARE_COLD_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7956A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7957@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a cold function
7958partition which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
7959cold partition of the function. The argument @var{decl} is the
7960@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7961
7962If this macro is not defined, then the partition size is not defined.
7963
7964You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
7965of this macro.
7966@end defmac
7967
a2c4f8e0 7968@defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
feca2ed3
JW
7969A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7970@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
7971initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
7972label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
7973@var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
7974
7975If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
7976usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7977
2be2ac70
ZW
7978You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7979@code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7980@end defmac
2be2ac70 7981
ad78130c 7982@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{expr}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
e4f7c483
AS
7983A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
7984for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
7985target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7986@code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
7987and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
7988will be an internal label.
18f3e349 7989
e4f7c483
AS
7990The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
7991usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
18f3e349 7992
e4f7c483
AS
7993You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
7994@end deftypefn
18f3e349 7995
a2c4f8e0 7996@defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
1cb36a98
RH
7997A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7998@var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
7999for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
8000
8001If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
8002nothing.
a2c4f8e0 8003@end defmac
1cb36a98 8004
a2c4f8e0 8005@defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
feca2ed3
JW
8006A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
8007once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
8008chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
8009initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
8010something about the size of the object.
8011
8012If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
8013nothing.
8014
2be2ac70
ZW
8015You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
8016@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
a2c4f8e0 8017@end defmac
2be2ac70 8018
5eb99654
KG
8019@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name})
8020This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
feca2ed3 8021@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
5eb99654 8022that is, available for reference from other files.
feca2ed3 8023
5eb99654
KG
8024The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
8025@code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
b65d23aa 8026@end deftypefn
072cdaed 8027
812b587e
SE
8028@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl})
8029This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8030@var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
8031global; that is, available for reference from other files.
8032
8033The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
8034@end deftypefn
8035
0d4b5b86
BS
8036@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_UNDEFINED_DECL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{decl})
8037This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8038@var{stream} some commands that will declare the name associated with
8039@var{decl} which is not defined in the current translation unit. Most
8040assemblers do not require anything to be output in this case.
8041@end deftypefn
8042
a2c4f8e0 8043@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
feca2ed3
JW
8044A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8045@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
8046that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
8047no other definition is available. Use the expression
8048@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
8049itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
8050for making that name weak, and a newline.
8051
79c4e63f
AM
8052If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
8053support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
8054macro.
a2c4f8e0 8055@end defmac
79c4e63f 8056
a2c4f8e0 8057@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
79c4e63f
AM
8058Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
8059@code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
8060or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
8061should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
8062defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8063@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
8064to make @var{name} weak.
a2c4f8e0 8065@end defmac
feca2ed3 8066
ff2d10c1
AO
8067@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8068Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
8069symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
8070declaration of @code{name}.
8071@end defmac
8072
a2c4f8e0 8073@defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
74b90fe2
JDA
8074A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
8075supports weak symbols.
feca2ed3
JW
8076
8077If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
79c4e63f 8078definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
74b90fe2
JDA
8079is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
8080@end defmac
8081
8082@defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
8083A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
8084
8085If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8086definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
8087this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
8088flag such as @option{-melf}.
a2c4f8e0 8089@end defmac
feca2ed3 8090
a2c4f8e0 8091@defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
feca2ed3
JW
8092A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
8093public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
8094be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
8095format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
8096section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
8097requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
a2c4f8e0 8098@end defmac
feca2ed3 8099
a2c4f8e0 8100@defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
feca2ed3
JW
8101A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
8102semantics.
8103
8104If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
8105definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
8106definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
e9a25f70 8107you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
feca2ed3
JW
8108setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
8109be emitted as one-only.
a2c4f8e0 8110@end defmac
feca2ed3 8111
914d25dc 8112@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl}, int @var{visibility})
93638d7a
AM
8113This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
8114commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
8115hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
8116@end deftypefn
8117
0524c91d 8118@defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
4746cf84 8119A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
0524c91d 8120that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
f676971a 8121The default is @code{0}.
0524c91d
MA
8122
8123Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
8124if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
8125will have undefined references from other translation units, that
8126symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
8127thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
8128(explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
8129with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
8130
8131The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
8132targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
8133restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
8134table of contents.
4746cf84
MA
8135@end defmac
8136
a2c4f8e0 8137@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
feca2ed3
JW
8138A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8139@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
8140symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
8141not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
8142declaration.
8143
8144This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
8145The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
a2c4f8e0 8146@end defmac
feca2ed3 8147
6773a41c
RO
8148@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (rtx @var{symref})
8149This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
feca2ed3 8150pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
6773a41c
RO
8151library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
8152@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 8153
914d25dc 8154@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED (const char *@var{symbol})
8e3e233b 8155This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
914d25dc
JR
8156directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
8157.no_dead_code_strip directive.
8e3e233b
DP
8158@end deftypefn
8159
a2c4f8e0 8160@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
feca2ed3
JW
8161A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8162@var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
8163@var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
8164is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
8165systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
a2c4f8e0 8166@end defmac
feca2ed3 8167
77754180
DK
8168@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_ASSEMBLER_NAME (const char *@var{name})
8169Given a symbol @var{name}, perform same mangling as @code{varasm.c}'s @code{assemble_name}, but in memory rather than to a file stream, returning result as an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE}. Required for correct LTO symtabs. The default implementation calls the @code{TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING} hook and then prepends the @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX}, if any.
8170@end deftypefn
8171
a2c4f8e0 8172@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
99c8c61c 8173A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
2f0b7af6 8174@code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
99c8c61c
AO
8175will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
8176to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
fb49053f 8177encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
a2c4f8e0 8178@end defmac
99c8c61c 8179
a2c4f8e0 8180@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
2f0b7af6 8181A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
4226378a 8182result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
2f0b7af6
GK
8183@code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
8184This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
8185specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
4226378a
PK
8186when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
8187being taken.
a2c4f8e0 8188@end defmac
2f0b7af6 8189
4977bab6
ZW
8190@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{prefix}, unsigned long @var{labelno})
8191A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8192name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
feca2ed3
JW
8193
8194It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8195used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
8196will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8197
8198It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8199object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8200should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8201beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
8202convention your system uses, and follow it.
8203
8a36672b 8204The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
4977bab6 8205@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 8206
a2c4f8e0 8207@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8215347e
JW
8208A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8209label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8210@var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8211may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8212systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8213bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8214bundles.
8215
4977bab6 8216If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8215347e 8217used.
a2c4f8e0 8218@end defmac
8215347e 8219
a2c4f8e0 8220@defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
feca2ed3
JW
8221A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8222is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8223
8224This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
4977bab6 8225produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
feca2ed3
JW
8226with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8227
8228If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8229output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8230@code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8231string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8232to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8233@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8234you should know what it does on your machine.)
a2c4f8e0 8235@end defmac
feca2ed3 8236
a2c4f8e0 8237@defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
feca2ed3
JW
8238A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8239@code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8240@var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8241added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8242
8243The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8244produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8245@var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8246assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8247macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8248internal static variables in different scopes.
8249
8250Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8251conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8252or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8253between the name and the number will suffice.
8254
4977bab6
ZW
8255If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8256which is correct for most systems.
a2c4f8e0 8257@end defmac
4977bab6 8258
a2c4f8e0 8259@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
feca2ed3
JW
8260A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8261which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8262
203cb4ef 8263@findex SET_ASM_OP
aee96fe9 8264If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
feca2ed3 8265correct for most systems.
a2c4f8e0 8266@end defmac
810e3c45 8267
a2c4f8e0 8268@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
e4faf1eb 8269A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
3b7a2e58 8270which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
e4faf1eb
NC
8271to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8272be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8273the tree nodes are available.
8274
203cb4ef 8275@findex SET_ASM_OP
aee96fe9 8276If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
956d6950 8277correct for most systems.
a2c4f8e0 8278@end defmac
956d6950 8279
083b6717
JDA
8280@defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8281A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8282(equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8283of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8284current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8285This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8286@samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8287@end defmac
8288
a2c4f8e0 8289@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
810e3c45
JM
8290A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8291which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
3aa8ab7b
L
8292@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8293an undefined weak symbol.
810e3c45
JM
8294
8295Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
aee96fe9 8296@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
a2c4f8e0 8297@end defmac
810e3c45 8298
a2c4f8e0 8299@defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
feca2ed3 8300Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
2147b154 8301Objective-C methods.
feca2ed3
JW
8302
8303The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8304class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8305the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8306@samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8307
8308These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8309the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8310systems define other ways of computing names.
8311
8312@var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8313buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8314@var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
831550 characters extra.
8316
8317The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8318method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
59d42021 8319@var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
feca2ed3
JW
8320in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8321
8322On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8323macro to provide more human-readable names.
a2c4f8e0 8324@end defmac
28df0b5a 8325
feca2ed3
JW
8326@node Initialization
8327@subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8328@cindex initialization routines
8329@cindex termination routines
8330@cindex constructors, output of
8331@cindex destructors, output of
8332
8333The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8334(also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8335data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8336to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8337@code{main} is called.
8338
8339Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8340@dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8341terminates.
8342
8343To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8344must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8345be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8346system, you need to specify how to do this.
8347
8348There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8349initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8350Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8351
8352@findex __CTOR_LIST__
8353@findex __DTOR_LIST__
8354The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8355initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8356termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8357
8358Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
83590, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8360the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8361pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8362pointer containing zero.
8363
8364Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8365@file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8366time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8367list; destructors in forward order.
8368
8369The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8370formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8371aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8372Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8373object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8374the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8375accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8376Termination functions are handled similarly.
8377
2cc07db4
RH
8378This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8379@code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
f282ffb3 8380support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
2cc07db4
RH
8381constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8382and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
feca2ed3
JW
8383
8384When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8385upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
2cc07db4 8386support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
feca2ed3 8387parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
05739753 8388program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
feca2ed3 8389
3ab51846 8390@smallexample
2cc07db4 8391ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
3ab51846 8392@end smallexample
feca2ed3 8393
2cc07db4
RH
8394The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8395section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8396for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8397files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8398are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8399
8400The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8401compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8402fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8403to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8404of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8405that invokes the routines we need at startup.
feca2ed3
JW
8406
8407To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8408macro properly.
8409
2cc07db4
RH
8410If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8411@code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8412entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8413it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8414after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8415in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
feca2ed3
JW
8416
8417In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8418two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8419and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
2cc07db4 8420@code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
feca2ed3
JW
8421entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8422and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8423code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
2cc07db4 8424the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
feca2ed3
JW
8425placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8426a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
2cc07db4 8427@code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
feca2ed3
JW
8428section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8429the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8430the initialization process.
8431
8432The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8433This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
161d7b59 8434file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
2cc07db4
RH
8435this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8436termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8437an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8438pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8439the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8440initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8441via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8442@code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
feca2ed3
JW
8443
8444@ifinfo
8445The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8446customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8447@end ifinfo
8448
8449@node Macros for Initialization
8450@subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8451
8452Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8453and termination functions:
8454
a2c4f8e0 8455@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
047c1c92
HPN
8456If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8457operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8458defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8459using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8460macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8461run the initialization functions.
a2c4f8e0 8462@end defmac
feca2ed3 8463
a2c4f8e0 8464@defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
feca2ed3 8465If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
2cc07db4
RH
8466This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8467on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8468be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
a2c4f8e0 8469@end defmac
feca2ed3 8470
a2c4f8e0 8471@defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
feca2ed3
JW
8472If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8473the following symbol is an initialization routine.
a2c4f8e0 8474@end defmac
feca2ed3 8475
a2c4f8e0 8476@defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
feca2ed3
JW
8477If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8478the following symbol is a finalization routine.
a2c4f8e0 8479@end defmac
feca2ed3 8480
a2c4f8e0 8481@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
414e05cf
RE
8482If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8483automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8484should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8485the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
172270b3 8486function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
414e05cf
RE
8487
8488This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
f282ffb3 8489shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
414e05cf 8490exception tables embedded in the code.
a2c4f8e0 8491@end defmac
414e05cf 8492
a2c4f8e0 8493@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
414e05cf
RE
8494If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8495automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8496should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8497the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
172270b3 8498function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
a2c4f8e0 8499@end defmac
414e05cf 8500
a2c4f8e0 8501@defmac INVOKE__main
feca2ed3
JW
8502If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8503@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8504where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8505useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
a2c4f8e0 8506@end defmac
feca2ed3 8507
a2c4f8e0 8508@defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
ea4f1fce
JO
8509If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8510compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8511of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8512encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
a2c4f8e0 8513@end defmac
2cc07db4 8514
914d25dc 8515@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
2cc07db4
RH
8516This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8517collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8518It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
914d25dc 8519@end deftypevr
2cc07db4
RH
8520
8521@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8522If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8523the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
ea4f1fce 8524
2cc07db4
RH
8525Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8526no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8527priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8528otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8529
14976c58 8530If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
2cc07db4
RH
8531be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8532target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8533is not defined.
8534@end deftypefn
8535
8536@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8537This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
feca2ed3 8538functions rather than initialization functions.
2cc07db4 8539@end deftypefn
14686fcd 8540
2cc07db4
RH
8541If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8542generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
feca2ed3 8543
2cc07db4
RH
8544If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8545constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8546an object file for constructor functions to be called.
14686fcd 8547
4a023207 8548On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
2cc07db4 8549@command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
feca2ed3 8550
a2c4f8e0 8551@defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
feca2ed3 8552Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
2cc07db4 8553object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
feca2ed3 8554object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
feca2ed3 8555
4a023207 8556This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
2cc07db4 8557part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
a2c4f8e0 8558@end defmac
feca2ed3 8559
a2c4f8e0 8560@defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
feca2ed3 8561Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
2cc07db4
RH
8562to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8563@command{nm}.
3e794bfe
RO
8564@end defmac
8565
8566@defmac NM_FLAGS
8567@command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
8568constructors and destructors and LTO info. By default, @option{-n} is
8569passed. Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
2b0d3573 8570are needed to get the same output format as GNU @command{nm -n}
3e794bfe
RO
8571produces.
8572@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
8573
8574If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8575dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8576these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8577termination functions in shared libraries:
8578
a2c4f8e0 8579@defmac LDD_SUFFIX
2cc07db4 8580Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
3e794bfe 8581which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
a2c4f8e0 8582@end defmac
feca2ed3 8583
a2c4f8e0 8584@defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
feca2ed3 8585Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
aee96fe9 8586of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
feca2ed3
JW
8587of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8588from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
aee96fe9
JM
8589code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8590line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
a2c4f8e0 8591@end defmac
feca2ed3 8592
881466d8
JDA
8593@defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8594Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8595library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8596strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8597constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8598that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8599@end defmac
8600
feca2ed3
JW
8601@node Instruction Output
8602@subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8603
8604@c prevent bad page break with this line
8605This describes assembler instruction output.
8606
a2c4f8e0 8607@defmac REGISTER_NAMES
feca2ed3
JW
8608A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8609registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8610register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
a2c4f8e0 8611@end defmac
feca2ed3 8612
a2c4f8e0 8613@defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
feca2ed3
JW
8614If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8615and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8616registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8617to registers using alternate names.
a2c4f8e0 8618@end defmac
feca2ed3 8619
0c6d290e
RE
8620@defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
8621If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
8622name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
8623machine registers the name overlaps. This macro defines additional
8624names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
8625declarations to refer to registers using alternate names. Unlike
8626@code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
8627register name implies multiple underlying registers.
8628
8629This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
8630@code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
8631register name. For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
8632VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
8633``s0'' and ``s1''.
8634@end defmac
8635
a2c4f8e0 8636@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
feca2ed3
JW
8637Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8638requires different names for the machine instructions.
8639
8640The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8641assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8642macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8643points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8644written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8645opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8646increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8647so that it will not be output twice.
8648
8649In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8650name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8651that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8652care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8653@var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8654
37bef197 8655@findex recog_data.operand
feca2ed3 8656If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
37bef197 8657elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
feca2ed3
JW
8658
8659If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8660in the usual way.
a2c4f8e0 8661@end defmac
feca2ed3 8662
a2c4f8e0 8663@defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
feca2ed3
JW
8664If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8665assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8666they will be output differently.
8667
8668Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8669extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8670elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8671The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8672template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8673by changing the contents of the vector.
8674
8675This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8676file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8677can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8678as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8679syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8680writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8681
8682If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
a2c4f8e0 8683@end defmac
feca2ed3 8684
ac44248e 8685@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN (FILE *@var{file}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx *@var{opvec}, int @var{noperands})
1afc5373
CF
8686If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8687output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8688if necessary.
8689
8690Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8691extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8692elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8693The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8694template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8695by checking the contents of the vector.
8696@end deftypefn
8697
a2c4f8e0 8698@defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
feca2ed3
JW
8699A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8700assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8701RTL expression.
8702
8703@var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8704of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8705printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8706the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8707operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8708@var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8709@var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8710
8711@findex reg_names
8712If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8713The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8714@code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8715@code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8716
8717When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8718(a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8719with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8720@var{code}.
a2c4f8e0 8721@end defmac
feca2ed3 8722
a2c4f8e0 8723@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
feca2ed3
JW
8724A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8725punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
8726@code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8727punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8728in this way.
a2c4f8e0 8729@end defmac
feca2ed3 8730
a2c4f8e0 8731@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
feca2ed3
JW
8732A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8733assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8734whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8735
fb49053f 8736@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
feca2ed3 8737On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
fb49053f
RH
8738section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
8739@code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
a2c4f8e0
ZW
8740@code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
8741Format}.
8742@end defmac
feca2ed3 8743
feca2ed3 8744@findex dbr_sequence_length
a2c4f8e0 8745@defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
feca2ed3
JW
8746A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8747been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8748determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8749currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8750or whatever.
8751
8752Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8753reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
e979f9e8 8754explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
a2c4f8e0 8755@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
8756
8757@findex final_sequence
8758Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
e979f9e8
JM
8759prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8760(i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
feca2ed3
JW
8761found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8762processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8763being output.
8764
feca2ed3 8765@findex asm_fprintf
a2c4f8e0
ZW
8766@defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
8767@defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
8768@defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
8769@defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
feca2ed3
JW
8770If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
8771@samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
8772@file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
8773support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
8774files can define these macros differently.
a2c4f8e0 8775@end defmac
feca2ed3 8776
a2c4f8e0 8777@defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
3b7a2e58 8778If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
fe0503ea
NC
8779statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
8780the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
8781printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
4bd0bee9 8782statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
fe0503ea
NC
8783generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
8784specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
8785The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
8786string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
8787upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
a2c4f8e0 8788@end defmac
fe0503ea 8789
a2c4f8e0 8790@defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
feca2ed3
JW
8791If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
8792different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
8793numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
8794first variant.
8795
8796If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
c237e94a 8797@smallexample
f282ffb3 8798@samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
c237e94a
ZW
8799@end smallexample
8800@noindent
8801in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
8802first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
8803@samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
8804@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
8805within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
8806alternatives within the braces than the value of
382522cb
MK
8807@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing. If it's needed
8808to print curly braces or @samp{|} character in assembler output directly,
8809@samp{%@{}, @samp{%@}} and @samp{%|} can be used.
feca2ed3
JW
8810
8811If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
8812@samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
8813operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
8814
8815Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
8816@code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
e5e809f4 8817the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
feca2ed3
JW
8818@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
8819if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
8820opcodes or operand order.
a2c4f8e0 8821@end defmac
feca2ed3 8822
a2c4f8e0 8823@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
feca2ed3
JW
8824A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8825which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
8826The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8827profiling.
a2c4f8e0 8828@end defmac
feca2ed3 8829
a2c4f8e0 8830@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
feca2ed3
JW
8831A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8832which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
8833The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8834profiling.
a2c4f8e0 8835@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
8836
8837@node Dispatch Tables
8838@subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
8839
8840@c prevent bad page break with this line
8841This concerns dispatch tables.
8842
feca2ed3 8843@cindex dispatch table
a2c4f8e0 8844@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
feca2ed3
JW
8845A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8846pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
8847@var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
8848definitions of these labels are output using
4977bab6 8849@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
feca2ed3
JW
8850way here. For example,
8851
3ab51846 8852@smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
8853fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
8854 @var{value}, @var{rel})
3ab51846 8855@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
8856
8857You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
f0523f02 8858dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
161d7b59 8859will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
aee96fe9 8860@var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
33f7f353 8861mode and flags can be read.
a2c4f8e0 8862@end defmac
feca2ed3 8863
a2c4f8e0 8864@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
feca2ed3
JW
8865This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
8866in a dispatch table are absolute.
8867
8868The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
8869@var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
8870a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
4977bab6 8871definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
feca2ed3
JW
8872For example,
8873
3ab51846 8874@smallexample
feca2ed3 8875fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
3ab51846 8876@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 8877@end defmac
feca2ed3 8878
a2c4f8e0 8879@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
feca2ed3
JW
8880Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
8881specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
4977bab6 8882@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
da5c6bde 8883jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_table_data} containing an
feca2ed3
JW
8884@code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
8885
8886This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
8887for the table.
8888
8889If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
4977bab6 8890@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
a2c4f8e0 8891@end defmac
feca2ed3 8892
a2c4f8e0 8893@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
feca2ed3
JW
8894Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
8895jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
8896after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
8897the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
8898@var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
8899of the preceding label.
8900
8901If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
8902the jump-table.
a2c4f8e0 8903@end defmac
feca2ed3 8904
914d25dc 8905@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl}, int @var{for_eh}, int @var{empty})
8a36672b 8906This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
4746cf84
MA
8907should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
8908should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
8909function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
eeab4d81
MS
8910The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
8911exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
8a36672b 8912true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
4746cf84
MA
8913
8914The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
8915@end deftypefn
8916
914d25dc 8917@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream})
083cad55
EC
8918This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
8919It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
8920to be broken up according to function.
8921
8922The default is that no label is emitted.
8923@end deftypefn
8924
a68b5e52
RH
8925@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY (rtx @var{personality})
8926If the target implements @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT}, this hook may be used to emit a directive to install a personality hook into the unwind info. This hook should not be used if dwarf2 unwind info is used.
8927@end deftypefn
8928
ac44248e 8929@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT (FILE *@var{stream}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
914d25dc 8930This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
f0a0390e
RH
8931given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
8932returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
951120ea
PB
8933@end deftypefn
8934
3bc6b3e6
RH
8935@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
8936True if the @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT} hook should be called before the assembly for @var{insn} has been emitted, false if the hook should be called afterward.
8937@end deftypevr
8938
02f52e19 8939@node Exception Region Output
feca2ed3
JW
8940@subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
8941
8942@c prevent bad page break with this line
8943
8944This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
8945region.
8946
a2c4f8e0 8947@defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
7c262518
RH
8948If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
8949exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
8950provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
8951@file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
0021b564
JM
8952
8953You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
8954unwind information and the default definition does not work.
a2c4f8e0 8955@end defmac
0021b564 8956
a2c4f8e0 8957@defmac EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
02c9b1ca
RH
8958If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
8959data section even though the target supports named sections. This
8960might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
8961collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
8962
8963Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
8964also defined.
a2c4f8e0 8965@end defmac
02c9b1ca 8966
1a35e62d
MM
8967@defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
8968Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
8969information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
8970runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
8971and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
8972@end defmac
8973
a2c4f8e0 8974@defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
aee96fe9 8975An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
feca2ed3 8976that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
a2c4f8e0 8977@end defmac
0021b564 8978
a2c4f8e0 8979@defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
0021b564
JM
8980Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8981information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
8982Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
01a07a64
SB
8983@code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}),
8984GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
f0a0390e 8985@end defmac
0021b564 8986
677f3fa8 8987@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
f0a0390e
RH
8988This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
8989by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
8990should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
8991@code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
8992should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8993information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
0021b564 8994
f0a0390e
RH
8995A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
8996This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
8997default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
0021b564 8998
f0a0390e 8999Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
d5fabb58
JM
9000not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
9001@var{opts}. In particular, the
f0a0390e
RH
9002setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
9003macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
9004depending on this setting.
9005
9006The default implementation of the hook first honors the
9007@option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
d5fabb58
JM
9008@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}. If
9009@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
9010must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
f0a0390e 9011@end deftypefn
951120ea 9012
677f3fa8 9013@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
617a1b71 9014This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
d5fabb58
JM
9015tables even when exceptions are not used. It must not be modified by
9016command-line option processing.
9e3be889 9017@end deftypevr
617a1b71 9018
4f6c2131
EB
9019@defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
9020Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
9021should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
9022instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
c14aea87
RO
9023@end defmac
9024
39ce30d8
SB
9025@defmac JMP_BUF_SIZE
9026This macro has no effect unless @code{DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP} is also
9027defined. Define this macro if the default size of @code{jmp_buf} buffer
9028for the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism
9029is not large enough, or if it is much too large.
9030The default size is @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER * sizeof(void *)}.
9031@end defmac
9032
a2c4f8e0 9033@defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
27c35f4b
HPN
9034This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
9035function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
9036@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
62f9f30b 9037alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is true, and the positive
27c35f4b
HPN
9038minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
9039the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
a2c4f8e0 9040@end defmac
feca2ed3 9041
9e3be889 9042@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
7606e68f
SS
9043Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
9044end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
9045Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
9046true otherwise.
9e3be889 9047@end deftypevr
7606e68f 9048
96714395
AH
9049@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN (rtx @var{reg})
9050Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
9051represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
9052register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
9053locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
9054register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
9055If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
9056@end deftypefn
9057
ef4bddc2 9058@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_DWARF_FRAME_REG_MODE (int @var{regno})
ff050c66
MF
9059Given a register, this hook should return the mode which the
9060corresponding Dwarf frame register should have. This is normally
9061used to return a smaller mode than the raw mode to prevent call
9062clobbered parts of a register altering the frame register size
9063@end deftypefn
9064
37ea0b7e
JM
9065@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA (tree @var{address})
9066If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
9067multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
9068sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
9069It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
9070filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
9071@var{address} is the address of the table.
9072@end deftypefn
9073
617a1b71
PB
9074@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_TTYPE (rtx @var{sym})
9075This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
9076the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
9077if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
9078reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
9079@end deftypefn
9080
914d25dc
JR
9081@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
9082This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
617a1b71
PB
9083based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
9084the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
9085running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
914d25dc 9086@end deftypevr
617a1b71 9087
feca2ed3
JW
9088@node Alignment Output
9089@subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
9090
9091@c prevent bad page break with this line
9092This describes commands for alignment.
9093
a2c4f8e0 9094@defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
247a370b 9095The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
f710504c 9096a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
25e22dc0
JH
9097
9098This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9099to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9100define the macro.
efa3896a 9101
3446405d
JH
9102Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9103to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
74f7912a 9104@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
247a370b 9105selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
a2c4f8e0 9106@end defmac
247a370b 9107
9158a0d8 9108@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
ad0c4c36
DD
9109The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
9110@code{JUMP_ALIGN}. This works only if
9111@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
9112@end deftypefn
9113
a2c4f8e0 9114@defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
247a370b
JH
9115The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
9116a @code{BARRIER}.
9117
9118This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9119to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9120define the macro.
a2c4f8e0 9121@end defmac
3446405d 9122
9158a0d8 9123@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
ad0c4c36 9124The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
efa3896a
GK
9125@code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
9126@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
ad0c4c36 9127@end deftypefn
efa3896a 9128
a2c4f8e0 9129@defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
58a51369
SB
9130The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label} that heads
9131a frequently executed basic block (usually the header of a loop).
feca2ed3
JW
9132
9133This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9134to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9135define the macro.
9136
efa3896a 9137Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
aee96fe9 9138to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
74f7912a 9139@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
aee96fe9 9140selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
a2c4f8e0 9141@end defmac
efa3896a 9142
9158a0d8 9143@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
ad0c4c36
DD
9144The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
9145@var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
9146defined.
9147@end deftypefn
efa3896a 9148
a2c4f8e0 9149@defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
fc470718 9150The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
aee96fe9 9151If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
fc470718
R
9152the maximum of the specified values is used.
9153
efa3896a 9154Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
aee96fe9 9155to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
74f7912a 9156@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
aee96fe9 9157selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
a2c4f8e0 9158@end defmac
efa3896a 9159
9158a0d8 9160@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
ad0c4c36
DD
9161The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
9162to @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
9163is defined.
9164@end deftypefn
efa3896a 9165
a2c4f8e0 9166@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
feca2ed3
JW
9167A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9168instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
9169Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
606e938d 9170expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
a2c4f8e0 9171@end defmac
feca2ed3 9172
a2c4f8e0 9173@defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
feca2ed3 9174Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
556e0f21 9175text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
feca2ed3
JW
9176This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
9177produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
9178section.
a2c4f8e0 9179@end defmac
feca2ed3 9180
a2c4f8e0 9181@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
feca2ed3
JW
9182A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9183command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9184@var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
a2c4f8e0 9185@end defmac
26f63a77 9186
a2c4f8e0 9187@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
8e16ab99
SF
9188Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
9189for padding, if necessary.
a2c4f8e0 9190@end defmac
8e16ab99 9191
a2c4f8e0 9192@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
26f63a77
JL
9193A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9194command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9195@var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
9196satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
9197a C expression of type @code{int}.
a2c4f8e0 9198@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
9199
9200@need 3000
9201@node Debugging Info
9202@section Controlling Debugging Information Format
9203
9204@c prevent bad page break with this line
9205This describes how to specify debugging information.
9206
9207@menu
9208* All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9209* DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9210* DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9211* File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9212* SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
5f98259a 9213* VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
feca2ed3
JW
9214@end menu
9215
9216@node All Debuggers
9217@subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9218
9219@c prevent bad page break with this line
9220These macros affect all debugging formats.
9221
a2c4f8e0 9222@defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
feca2ed3 9223A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
4617e3b5
KG
9224register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9225of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9226some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9227versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9228compiler and another for DBX@.
feca2ed3 9229
a3a15b4d 9230If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
feca2ed3
JW
9231used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9232consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9233Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9234expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9235
9236If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9237does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9238redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
a2c4f8e0 9239@end defmac
feca2ed3 9240
a2c4f8e0 9241@defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
feca2ed3
JW
9242A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9243variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9244computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9245gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9246that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9247for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
630d3d5a 9248@option{-g} options is used.
a2c4f8e0 9249@end defmac
feca2ed3 9250
a2c4f8e0 9251@defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
feca2ed3
JW
9252A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9253having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9254@var{offset}.
a2c4f8e0 9255@end defmac
feca2ed3 9256
a2c4f8e0 9257@defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
a3a15b4d 9258A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
630d3d5a 9259produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
a3a15b4d 9260this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
e5e809f4 9261debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
5f98259a
RK
9262@code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9263@code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
feca2ed3 9264
630d3d5a 9265When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
e5e809f4 9266value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
16201823 9267exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
e5e809f4 9268value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
a3a15b4d 9269defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
deabc777 9270
feca2ed3 9271The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
630d3d5a 9272user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
def66b10 9273@option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
a2c4f8e0 9274@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
9275
9276@node DBX Options
9277@subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9278
9279@c prevent bad page break with this line
9280These are specific options for DBX output.
9281
a2c4f8e0 9282@defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
a3a15b4d 9283Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
630d3d5a 9284in response to the @option{-g} option.
a2c4f8e0 9285@end defmac
feca2ed3 9286
a2c4f8e0 9287@defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
a3a15b4d 9288Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
630d3d5a 9289in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
a2c4f8e0 9290@end defmac
feca2ed3 9291
a2c4f8e0 9292@defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
a3a15b4d 9293Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
feca2ed3
JW
9294GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9295debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9296macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9297if there is any occasion to.
a2c4f8e0 9298@end defmac
feca2ed3 9299
a2c4f8e0 9300@defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
feca2ed3
JW
9301Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9302in the text section.
a2c4f8e0 9303@end defmac
feca2ed3 9304
a2c4f8e0 9305@defmac ASM_STABS_OP
047c1c92
HPN
9306A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9307use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9308If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9309applies only to DBX debugging information format.
a2c4f8e0 9310@end defmac
feca2ed3 9311
a2c4f8e0 9312@defmac ASM_STABD_OP
047c1c92
HPN
9313A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9314use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9315value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9316@code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9317information format.
a2c4f8e0 9318@end defmac
feca2ed3 9319
a2c4f8e0 9320@defmac ASM_STABN_OP
047c1c92
HPN
9321A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9322use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9323name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9324macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
a2c4f8e0 9325@end defmac
feca2ed3 9326
a2c4f8e0 9327@defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
feca2ed3
JW
9328Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9329@samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9330describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9331On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
a2c4f8e0 9332@end defmac
feca2ed3 9333
a2c4f8e0 9334@defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
feca2ed3
JW
9335A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9336continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9337exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9338operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9339must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9340with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9341defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
a2c4f8e0 9342@end defmac
feca2ed3 9343
a2c4f8e0 9344@defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
feca2ed3
JW
9345Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9346the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9347a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9348constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9349if backslash is correct for your system.
a2c4f8e0 9350@end defmac
feca2ed3 9351
a2c4f8e0 9352@defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
feca2ed3
JW
9353Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9354outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9355variable.
a2c4f8e0 9356@end defmac
feca2ed3 9357
a2c4f8e0 9358@defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
feca2ed3
JW
9359The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9360for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
a2c4f8e0 9361@end defmac
feca2ed3 9362
a2c4f8e0 9363@defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
feca2ed3
JW
9364The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9365for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9366provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
a2c4f8e0 9367@end defmac
feca2ed3 9368
a2c4f8e0 9369@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
feca2ed3
JW
9370The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9371for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9372``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
a2c4f8e0 9373@end defmac
feca2ed3 9374
a2c4f8e0 9375@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
feca2ed3
JW
9376The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9377passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9378do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
a2c4f8e0 9379@end defmac
feca2ed3 9380
a2c4f8e0 9381@defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
feca2ed3
JW
9382Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9383arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9384in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9385code.
a2c4f8e0 9386@end defmac
feca2ed3 9387
a2c4f8e0 9388@defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
3e487b21
ZW
9389Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9390the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9391relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9392an absolute address.
9393@end defmac
9394
9395@defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9396Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9397the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9398start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
a2c4f8e0 9399@end defmac
feca2ed3 9400
a2c4f8e0 9401@defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
f0523f02 9402Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
feca2ed3 9403@code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
f0523f02
JM
9404macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9405number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
feca2ed3
JW
9406generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9407number for a type number.
a2c4f8e0 9408@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
9409
9410@node DBX Hooks
9411@subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9412
9413@c prevent bad page break with this line
9414These are hooks for DBX format.
9415
3e487b21
ZW
9416@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9417A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9418number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
8a36672b 9419@var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
3e487b21
ZW
9420invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9421unique labels in the assembly output.
9422
9423This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9424if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9425@end defmac
9426
a2c4f8e0 9427@defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
feca2ed3 9428Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
c771326b 9429@code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
feca2ed3
JW
9430On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9431disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
a2c4f8e0 9432@end defmac
feca2ed3 9433
5d865dac
EB
9434@defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9435Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9436extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9437feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9438@end defmac
9439
feca2ed3
JW
9440@node File Names and DBX
9441@subsection File Names in DBX Format
9442
9443@c prevent bad page break with this line
9444This describes file names in DBX format.
9445
a2c4f8e0 9446@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
feca2ed3 9447A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
93a27b7b 9448@var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
feca2ed3
JW
9449file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9450This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9451
9452This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9453for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
93a27b7b
ZW
9454
9455It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9456text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9457to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9458@var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
a2c4f8e0 9459@end defmac
feca2ed3 9460
93a27b7b
ZW
9461@defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9462Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9463of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9464the beginning of the file.
9465@end defmac
feca2ed3 9466
93a27b7b
ZW
9467@defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9468Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9469that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9470an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9471@samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
a2c4f8e0 9472@end defmac
feca2ed3 9473
a2c4f8e0 9474@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
feca2ed3 9475A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
93a27b7b
ZW
9476compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9477written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
feca2ed3
JW
9478
9479If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9480of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
a2c4f8e0 9481@end defmac
feca2ed3 9482
3e487b21
ZW
9483@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9484Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9485@code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
e4ae5e77 9486the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
3e487b21
ZW
9487whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9488@end defmac
9489
feca2ed3
JW
9490@need 2000
9491@node SDB and DWARF
9492@subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9493
9494@c prevent bad page break with this line
9495Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9496
a2c4f8e0 9497@defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
a3a15b4d 9498Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
630d3d5a 9499for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
a2c4f8e0 9500@end defmac
feca2ed3 9501
a2c4f8e0 9502@defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
a3a15b4d 9503Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
630d3d5a 9504debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
f3ff3f4a 9505
b6fd8800 9506@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION (const_tree @var{function})
a1c496cb
EC
9507Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9508be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9509value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9510@end deftypefn
9511
861bb6c1
JL
9512To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9513define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9514@code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9515prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
08c148a8 9516as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
a2c4f8e0 9517@end defmac
861bb6c1 9518
a2c4f8e0 9519@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
a3a15b4d 9520Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
f0a0390e
RH
9521Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9522(@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9523exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9524how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
a2c4f8e0 9525@end defmac
9ec36da5 9526
f0a0390e
RH
9527@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO (void)
9528This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9529unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9530@code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9531return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9532
9533A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9534is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9535
9536A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9537This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9538@end deftypefn
9539
a2c4f8e0 9540@defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
b2244e22
JW
9541Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9542line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9543tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
a2c4f8e0 9544@end defmac
b2244e22 9545
9730bc27
TT
9546@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9547True if the @code{.debug_pubtypes} and @code{.debug_pubnames} sections should be emitted. These sections are not used on most platforms, and in particular GDB does not use them.
9548@end deftypevr
9549
638c962f
JH
9550@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FORCE_AT_COMP_DIR
9551True if the @code{DW_AT_comp_dir} attribute should be emitted for each compilation unit. This attribute is required for the darwin linker to emit debug information.
9552@end deftypevr
9553
2ba42841 9554@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_SCHED2
a50fa76a
BS
9555True if sched2 is not to be run at its normal place.
9556This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
2ba42841
AO
9557@end deftypevr
9558
9559@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_VARTRACK
a50fa76a
BS
9560True if vartrack is not to be run at its normal place.
9561This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
9562@end deftypevr
9563
9564@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NO_REGISTER_ALLOCATION
9565True if register allocation and the passes
9566following it should not be run. Usually true only for virtual assembler
9567targets.
2ba42841
AO
9568@end deftypevr
9569
a2c4f8e0 9570@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
7606e68f 9571A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
192d0f89 9572@var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
a2c4f8e0 9573@end defmac
7606e68f 9574
67ad2ae7
DR
9575@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9576A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9577between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9578slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9579@end defmac
9580
192d0f89 9581@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
7606e68f 9582A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
192d0f89
GK
9583section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
9584given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
a2c4f8e0 9585@end defmac
7606e68f 9586
a2c4f8e0 9587@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
7606e68f 9588A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
192d0f89 9589reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
a2c4f8e0 9590@end defmac
7606e68f 9591
7e49a4b3
OH
9592@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9593A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9594the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9595is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9596is referenced by a function.
9597@end defmac
9598
914d25dc 9599@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{size}, rtx @var{x})
fdbe66f2
EB
9600If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9601reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9602@end deftypefn
9603
a2c4f8e0 9604@defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
feca2ed3
JW
9605Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9606SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9607macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9608not define them yourself.
a2c4f8e0 9609@end defmac
feca2ed3 9610
a2c4f8e0 9611@defmac SDB_DELIM
feca2ed3
JW
9612Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9613SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9614delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9615a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9616required.
a2c4f8e0 9617@end defmac
feca2ed3 9618
a2c4f8e0 9619@defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
feca2ed3
JW
9620Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9621union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9622allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9623it.
a2c4f8e0 9624@end defmac
feca2ed3 9625
a2c4f8e0 9626@defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
feca2ed3
JW
9627Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9628enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9629assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
a2c4f8e0 9630@end defmac
feca2ed3 9631
3e487b21
ZW
9632@defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9633A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9634number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9635@var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9636@end defmac
9637
5f98259a
RK
9638@need 2000
9639@node VMS Debug
9640@subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9641
9642@c prevent bad page break with this line
9643Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9644
a2c4f8e0 9645@defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
5f98259a
RK
9646Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9647in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9648is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9649@option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
fac0f722 9650behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
74f7912a 9651@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
a2c4f8e0 9652@end defmac
5f98259a 9653
b216cd4a 9654@node Floating Point
feca2ed3
JW
9655@section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9656@cindex cross compilation and floating point
9657@cindex floating point and cross compilation
9658
b216cd4a 9659While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
feca2ed3
JW
9660there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9661means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9662in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9663doing the compilation.
9664
feca2ed3 9665Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
b216cd4a
ZW
9666range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9667the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9668safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9669the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9670emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9671target floating point formats are identical.
9672
9673The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9674use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
ba31d94e
ZW
9675floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9676their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
feca2ed3 9677
b216cd4a
ZW
9678@defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9679The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9680machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9681array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9682quantity.
9683@end defmac
9684
9685@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9686Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}. If the target
9687floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
9688@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
9689@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
9690@end deftypefn
9691
9692@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9693Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
9694@end deftypefn
9695
b216cd4a
ZW
9696@deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9697Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9698@end deftypefn
9699
9700@deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9701Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9702@var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9703@end deftypefn
9704
ef4bddc2 9705@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, machine_mode @var{mode})
b216cd4a
ZW
9706Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9707representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9708decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9709defined by the C language for both.
9710@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 9711
15e5ad76 9712@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
ce3649d2 9713Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
15e5ad76
ZW
9714@end deftypefn
9715
b216cd4a
ZW
9716@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9717Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9718@end deftypefn
9719
9720@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9721Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9722@end deftypefn
9723
9724@deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9725Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
9726@var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
9727variable).
9728
9729The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}. Only the
9730following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
9731@code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
9732
9733If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
9734target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
9735@code{abort}. Callers should check for this situation first, using
9736@code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}. @xref{Storage Layout}.
9737@end deftypefn
9738
9739@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9740Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9741@end deftypefn
9742
15e5ad76
ZW
9743@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9744Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9745@end deftypefn
9746
9f09b1f2
R
9747@node Mode Switching
9748@section Mode Switching Instructions
9749@cindex mode switching
9750The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9751
a2c4f8e0 9752@defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9f09b1f2
R
9753Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9754switching in an optimizing compilation.
9755
9756For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9757floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9758the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9759operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
9760purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
e979f9e8 9761be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
18dbd950 9762or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9f09b1f2
R
9763
9764You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9765which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
14976c58 9766return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9f09b1f2 9767If you define this macro, you also have to define
06b90602
CB
9768@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{TARGET_MODE_NEEDED},
9769@code{TARGET_MODE_PRIORITY} and @code{TARGET_MODE_EMIT}.
9770@code{TARGET_MODE_AFTER}, @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT}
73774972 9771are optional.
a2c4f8e0 9772@end defmac
9f09b1f2 9773
a2c4f8e0 9774@defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9f09b1f2
R
9775If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9776initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
9777N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9778of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
78466c0e
JM
9779The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9780zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9f09b1f2
R
9781entity in question.
9782In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
630d3d5a 9783represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
9f09b1f2 9784switch is needed / supplied.
a2c4f8e0 9785@end defmac
9f09b1f2 9786
cbb1e3d9
CB
9787@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MODE_EMIT (int @var{entity}, int @var{mode}, int @var{prev_mode}, HARD_REG_SET @var{regs_live})
9788Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}. @var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where the insn(s) are to be inserted. @var{prev_moxde} indicates the mode to switch from. Sets of a lower numbered entity will be emitted before sets of a higher numbered entity to a mode of the same or lower priority.
06b90602 9789@end deftypefn
9f09b1f2 9790
ac44248e 9791@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_NEEDED (int @var{entity}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
cbb1e3d9 9792@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
06b90602 9793@end deftypefn
73774972 9794
ac44248e 9795@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_AFTER (int @var{entity}, int @var{mode}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
06b90602
CB
9796@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if different from the incoming mode).
9797@end deftypefn
73774972 9798
06b90602
CB
9799@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_ENTRY (int @var{entity})
9800If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY} is defined then @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
9801@end deftypefn
9f09b1f2 9802
06b90602
CB
9803@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_EXIT (int @var{entity})
9804If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT} is defined then @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
9805@end deftypefn
9f09b1f2 9806
06b90602
CB
9807@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_PRIORITY (int @var{entity}, int @var{n})
9808This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed. 0 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority} (@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{} @code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
9809@end deftypefn
9f09b1f2 9810
91d231cb
JM
9811@node Target Attributes
9812@section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
9813@cindex target attributes
9814@cindex machine attributes
9815@cindex attributes, target-specific
9816
9817Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
9818These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
9819be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
9820
9821@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct attribute_spec *} TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9822If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
15ab4e1e 9823attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree-core.h}) specifying the machine
91d231cb
JM
9824specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
9825entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
9826take.
9827@end deftypevr
9828
564a129d
JM
9829@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P (const_tree @var{name})
9830If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
9831machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
9832given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
9833subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
9834false for all machine-specific attributes.
9835@end deftypefn
9836
b6fd8800 9837@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
91d231cb
JM
9838If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
9839@var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
9840and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
9841generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
9842supposed always to be compatible.
9843@end deftypefn
9844
9845@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type})
9846If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
914d25dc 9847the newly defined @var{type}.
91d231cb
JM
9848@end deftypefn
9849
9850@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
9851Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
9852handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9853@code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
9854that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
9855function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
9856merging.
9857@end deftypefn
9858
9859@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl})
9860Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
9861handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9862@code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
9863@var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
9864when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
9865attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
9866call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
9867
9868@findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
b2ca3702
MM
9869If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
9870for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
9871@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
9872will then define a function called
9873@code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
9874the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
9875add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
9876to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
9877@samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
9878@file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
91d231cb
JM
9879@end deftypefn
9880
b6fd8800 9881@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P (const_tree @var{decl})
38f8b050 9882@var{decl} is a variable or function with @code{__attribute__((dllimport))} specified. Use this hook if the target needs to add extra validation checks to @code{handle_dll_attribute}.
43d9ad1d
DS
9883@end deftypefn
9884
63c5b495 9885@defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
1a141fe1 9886Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
63c5b495
MM
9887@code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
9888default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
9889@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
9890of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
9891on this implementation detail.
9892@end defmac
9893
91d231cb
JM
9894@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr})
9895Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
9896when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
9897wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
9898the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
9899created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
9900for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
9901shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
9902the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
9903attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
9904needed.
9905@end deftypefn
9906
65a324b4 9907@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P (const_tree @var{fndecl})
91d231cb 9908@cindex inlining
5bd40ade 9909This target hook returns @code{true} if it is OK to inline @var{fndecl}
91d231cb
JM
9910into the current function, despite its having target-specific
9911attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
9912target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
9913@end deftypefn
9914
914d25dc 9915@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{name}, tree @var{args}, int @var{flags})
7aa7f2e3
SL
9916This hook is called to parse @code{attribute(target("..."))}, which
9917allows setting target-specific options on individual functions.
9918These function-specific options may differ
9919from the options specified on the command line. The hook should return
ab442df7
MM
9920@code{true} if the options are valid.
9921
7aa7f2e3
SL
9922The hook should set the @code{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
9923the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target-specific
9924@code{struct cl_target_option} structure.
ab442df7
MM
9925@end deftypefn
9926
bf7b5747 9927@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_SAVE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
7aa7f2e3
SL
9928This hook is called to save any additional target-specific information
9929in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for function-specific
bf7b5747 9930options from the @code{struct gcc_options} structure.
ab442df7
MM
9931@xref{Option file format}.
9932@end deftypefn
9933
bf7b5747 9934@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
7aa7f2e3
SL
9935This hook is called to restore any additional target-specific
9936information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for
bf7b5747 9937function-specific options to the @code{struct gcc_options} structure.
ab442df7
MM
9938@end deftypefn
9939
59913123
JJ
9940@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_POST_STREAM_IN (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9941This hook is called to update target-specific information in the
9942@code{struct cl_target_option} structure after it is streamed in from
9943LTO bytecode.
9944@end deftypefn
9945
d2143a2f 9946@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_PRINT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{indent}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
7aa7f2e3
SL
9947This hook is called to print any additional target-specific
9948information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9949function-specific options.
ab442df7
MM
9950@end deftypefn
9951
56cb42ea 9952@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE (tree @var{args}, tree @var{pop_target})
7aa7f2e3
SL
9953This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC target}, which
9954sets the target-specific options for functions that occur later in the
9955input stream. The options accepted should be the same as those handled by the
56cb42ea 9956@code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
ab442df7
MM
9957@end deftypefn
9958
74f7912a
JR
9959@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE (void)
9960Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
9961a particular target machine. You can override the hook
9962@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
9963once just after all the command options have been parsed.
9964
9965Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
fac0f722 9966@option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
74f7912a
JR
9967
9968If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
9969changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
9970@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
9971@end deftypefn
9972
3649b9b7
ST
9973@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_FUNCTION_VERSIONS (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
9974This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are
9975versions of the same function. @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are function
9976versions if and only if they have the same function signature and
9977different target specific attributes, that is, they are compiled for
9978different target machines.
9979@end deftypefn
9980
ab442df7
MM
9981@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P (tree @var{caller}, tree @var{callee})
9982This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
9983cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
9984default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
9985specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
9986@end deftypefn
9987
feb60f03
NS
9988@node Emulated TLS
9989@section Emulating TLS
9990@cindex Emulated TLS
9991
9992For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
9993specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
9994used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
9995configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
a640c13b 9996the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
feb60f03
NS
9997layer.
9998
9999The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
10000object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
10001which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
10002address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
10003
10004@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
10005Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
10006object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
10007emulated TLS helper function to be used.
10008@end deftypevr
10009
10010@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
10011Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
10012program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
10013initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
10014have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
10015registration function to be used.
10016@end deftypevr
10017
10018@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
10019Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
10020be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
10021any section.
10022@end deftypevr
10023
10024@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
10025Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
10026placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
10027section.
10028@end deftypevr
10029
10030@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
10031Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
10032The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
10033@end deftypevr
10034
10035@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
10036Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
10037default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
10038@end deftypevr
10039
10040@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS (tree @var{type}, tree *@var{name})
10041Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
10042object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
10043@var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
10044@code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
10045for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
10046@end deftypefn
10047
10048@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT (tree @var{var}, tree @var{decl}, tree @var{tmpl_addr})
10049Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
10050TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
10051is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
10052initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
10053@end deftypefn
10054
b6fd8800 10055@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
feb60f03
NS
10056Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
10057fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
10058single objects. The default is false.
10059@end deftypevr
10060
b6fd8800 10061@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
feb60f03
NS
10062Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
10063may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
10064@end deftypevr
10065
d604bca3
MH
10066@node MIPS Coprocessors
10067@section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
10068@cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
10069
10070The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
2dd76960 10071coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
d604bca3
MH
10072accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
10073and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
10074
10075@smallexample
10076 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
10077 unsigned int d;
10078
10079 d = cp0count + 3;
10080@end smallexample
10081
10082(``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
10083names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
10084overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
10085
10086Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
10087be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
10088later in the function.
10089
10090Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
8a36672b 10091the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
d604bca3
MH
10092floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
10093
7bb1ad93
GK
10094@node PCH Target
10095@section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
10096@cindex parameters, precompiled headers
10097
0678ade0 10098@deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY (size_t *@var{sz})
914d25dc
JR
10099This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
10100@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
0678ade0 10101@samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
7bb1ad93
GK
10102@end deftypefn
10103
b6fd8800 10104@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_PCH_VALID_P (const void *@var{data}, size_t @var{sz})
8d932be3
RS
10105This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
10106compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
10107if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
10108be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
10109
10110@var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
10111when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
10112It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
10113compiler, so no format checking is needed.
10114
10115The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
10116suitable for most targets.
10117@end deftypefn
10118
b6fd8800 10119@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS (int @var{pch_flags})
8d932be3
RS
10120If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
10121@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
10122of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
10123@code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
10124value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
7bb1ad93
GK
10125@end deftypefn
10126
e32ea2d1
RS
10127@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_PREPARE_PCH_SAVE (void)
10128Called before writing out a PCH file. If the target has some
10129garbage-collected data that needs to be in a particular state on PCH loads,
10130it can use this hook to enforce that state. Very few targets need
10131to do anything here.
10132@end deftypefn
10133
4185ae53
PB
10134@node C++ ABI
10135@section C++ ABI parameters
10136@cindex parameters, c++ abi
10137
10138@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE (void)
10139Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
10140These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
10141default is long_long_integer_type_node.
10142@end deftypefn
10143
10144@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT (void)
f676971a 10145This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
914d25dc
JR
10146@code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
10147@code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
4185ae53
PB
10148@end deftypefn
10149
46e995e0
PB
10150@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE (tree @var{type})
10151This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
10152whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
10153known that a cookie is needed. The default is
10154@code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
8a36672b 10155IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
46e995e0
PB
10156@end deftypefn
10157
10158@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE (void)
10159This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
10160array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
10161@end deftypefn
10162
38f8b050 10163@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS (tree @var{type}, int @var{import_export})
d59c7b4b
NC
10164If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
10165class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
78466c0e 10166will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
d59c7b4b
NC
10167to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
10168modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
10169backend's targeted operating system.
10170@end deftypefn
10171
44d10c10
PB
10172@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS (void)
10173This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
10174the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
10175@code{false}.
10176@end deftypefn
10177
af287697
MM
10178@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE (void)
10179This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
10180which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
10181table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
10182Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
10183the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
10184some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
10185method. The default is to return @code{true}.
10186@end deftypefn
10187
1e731102 10188@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl})
38f8b050 10189@var{decl} is a virtual table, virtual table table, typeinfo object, or other similar implicit class data object that will be emitted with external linkage in this translation unit. No ELF visibility has been explicitly specified. If the target needs to specify a visibility other than that of the containing class, use this hook to set @code{DECL_VISIBILITY} and @code{DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED}.
1e731102
MM
10190@end deftypefn
10191
10192@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT (void)
10193This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10194similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10195external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
10196classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10197unit will not be COMDAT.
505970fc
MM
10198@end deftypefn
10199
157600d0
GK
10200@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT (void)
10201This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10202the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10203be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10204@end deftypefn
10205
9f62c3e3
PB
10206@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT (void)
10207This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10208should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10209is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10210@end deftypefn
10211
97388150
DS
10212@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT (void)
10213This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10214in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10215destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10216shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10217unloaded. The default is to return false.
10218@end deftypefn
10219
43d9ad1d 10220@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION (tree @var{type})
38f8b050 10221@var{type} is a C++ class (i.e., RECORD_TYPE or UNION_TYPE) that has just been defined. Use this hook to make adjustments to the class (eg, tweak visibility or perform any other required target modifications).
43d9ad1d
DS
10222@end deftypefn
10223
5b880ea6
RO
10224@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_DECL_MANGLING_CONTEXT (const_tree @var{decl})
10225Return target-specific mangling context of @var{decl} or @code{NULL_TREE}.
10226@end deftypefn
10227
09e881c9
BE
10228@node Named Address Spaces
10229@section Adding support for named address spaces
10230@cindex named address spaces
10231
10232The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10233standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10234support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10235processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10236GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10237address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10238spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10239@code{const} type attributes.
10240
02a9370c 10241Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
09e881c9
BE
10242pointers to the generic address space.
10243
10244For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10245to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10246processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10247issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10248local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10249address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10250@option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10251always 32 bits).
10252
10253Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10254range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10255address space.
10256
3ef0694c
UW
10257To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10258the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10259the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10260named address space #1:
36c5e70a
BE
10261@smallexample
10262#define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
3ef0694c 10263c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
36c5e70a 10264@end smallexample
36c5e70a 10265
ef4bddc2 10266@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
d4ebfa65
BE
10267Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10268@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10269The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode} for the
10270generic address space only.
10271@end deftypefn
10272
ef4bddc2 10273@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
d4ebfa65
BE
10274Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10275@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10276The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode} for the
10277generic address space only.
10278@end deftypefn
10279
ef4bddc2 10280@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
d4ebfa65
BE
10281Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10282with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10283hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10284except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10285version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10286@code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10287target hooks for the given address space.
10288@end deftypefn
10289
ef4bddc2 10290@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{exp}, bool @var{strict}, addr_space_t @var{as})
09e881c9
BE
10291Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10292@var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10293parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10294finished. This target hook is the same as the
10295@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10296explicit named address space support.
10297@end deftypefn
10298
ef4bddc2 10299@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
09e881c9
BE
10300Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10301with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10302hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10303except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10304@end deftypefn
10305
b5bcaa4a 10306@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P (addr_space_t @var{subset}, addr_space_t @var{superset})
09e881c9
BE
10307Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10308contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10309a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10310will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10311arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
a4ce9883 10312converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
09e881c9
BE
10313@end deftypefn
10314
b6fd8800 10315@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT (rtx @var{op}, tree @var{from_type}, tree @var{to_type})
09e881c9
BE
10316Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10317@var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10318space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10319to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10320guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10321as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10322@end deftypefn
10323
feca2ed3
JW
10324@node Misc
10325@section Miscellaneous Parameters
10326@cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10327
10328@c prevent bad page break with this line
10329Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10330
e543e219
ZW
10331@defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10332Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10333has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10334conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10335blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10336set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10337to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10338@end defmac
10339
10340@defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10341Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10342has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10343conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10344blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10345set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10346to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
a2c4f8e0 10347@end defmac
8fe0ca0c 10348
a2c4f8e0 10349@defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
feca2ed3
JW
10350An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10351elements of a jump-table should have.
a2c4f8e0 10352@end defmac
feca2ed3 10353
a2c4f8e0 10354@defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
33f7f353
JR
10355Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10356when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10357it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
4226378a 10358To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
33f7f353 10359make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
391aaa6b 10360The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
33f7f353 10361flags can be updated.
a2c4f8e0 10362@end defmac
33f7f353 10363
a2c4f8e0 10364@defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
18543a22 10365Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
9c49953c
KH
10366should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10367jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10368contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10369is in effect.
a2c4f8e0 10370@end defmac
feca2ed3 10371
b6fd8800 10372@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD (void)
e6ff3083 10373This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
feca2ed3
JW
10374is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10375The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10376five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
e6ff3083 10377@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 10378
a2c4f8e0 10379@defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
feca2ed3
JW
10380Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
10381smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10382Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
a2c4f8e0 10383@end defmac
feca2ed3 10384
7be4d808 10385@defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
feca2ed3 10386Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
7be4d808
R
10387memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10388bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
feca2ed3 10389zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
7be4d808 10390of @var{mem_mode} for which the
feca2ed3 10391insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
f822d252 10392@code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
feca2ed3 10393
7be4d808 10394This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
feca2ed3
JW
10395greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10396value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
f822d252 10397@code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
feca2ed3 10398define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
7be4d808 10399
f822d252 10400You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
7be4d808
R
10401the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10402of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10403when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10404integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10405
f822d252 10406You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
7be4d808
R
10407mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10408@code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10409is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
a2c4f8e0 10410@end defmac
feca2ed3 10411
a2c4f8e0 10412@defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
77643ab8
MM
10413Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10414extends.
a2c4f8e0 10415@end defmac
77643ab8 10416
ef4bddc2 10417@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL (machine_mode @var{mode})
bc23502b
PB
10418When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10419divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10420the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10421that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10422of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10423has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10424@end deftypefn
10425
a2c4f8e0 10426@defmac MOVE_MAX
feca2ed3
JW
10427The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10428between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
a2c4f8e0 10429@end defmac
feca2ed3 10430
a2c4f8e0 10431@defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
feca2ed3
JW
10432The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10433between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10434is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10435constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10436at run-time.
a2c4f8e0 10437@end defmac
feca2ed3 10438
a2c4f8e0 10439@defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
feca2ed3
JW
10440A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10441actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10442of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
df2a54e9 10443this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
feca2ed3
JW
10444a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10445truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
c771326b 10446instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
feca2ed3
JW
10447include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10448also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
c771326b 10449arguments to bit-field instructions.
feca2ed3
JW
10450
10451If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
c771326b 10452position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
feca2ed3
JW
10453instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10454
10455However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10456only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
c771326b 10457bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
feca2ed3
JW
10458such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10459the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10460
10461You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
a2c4f8e0 10462@end defmac
feca2ed3 10463
273a2526 10464@anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
ef4bddc2 10465@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK (machine_mode @var{mode})
273a2526
RS
10466This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10467deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10468@xref{shift patterns}.
10469
10470On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10471shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10472equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10473this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10474otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10475particular behavior is guaranteed.
10476
10477Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10478@emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10479that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10480
10481The default implementation of this function returns
10482@code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10483and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10484@code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10485nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10486by overriding it.
10487@end deftypefn
10488
a2c4f8e0 10489@defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
feca2ed3
JW
10490A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10491``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10492bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10493operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10494
10495On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10496
10497@c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10498@c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10499When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10500modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10501If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10502such cases may improve things.
a2c4f8e0 10503@end defmac
feca2ed3 10504
ef4bddc2 10505@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (machine_mode @var{mode}, machine_mode @var{rep_mode})
66a4ad37 10506The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
b12cbf2c
AN
10507are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10508@code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10509sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10510otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10511representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10512@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10513@code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
914d25dc 10514@var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
b12cbf2c
AN
10515widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10516
10517Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10518value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10519as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10520@code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10521
10522Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10523describe two related properties. If you define
10524@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10525to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10526extension.
10527
10528In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10529@code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10530@code{mode}.
10531@end deftypefn
10532
a2c4f8e0 10533@defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
feca2ed3
JW
10534A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10535with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
ac5eda13
PB
10536(@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10537apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
feca2ed3
JW
10538comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10539
630d3d5a
JM
10540A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10541comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
feca2ed3
JW
10542and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10543which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10544true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10545operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
ac5eda13 10546@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
feca2ed3
JW
10547@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10548the compiler.
10549
630d3d5a 10550If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
feca2ed3
JW
10551generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10552replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10553the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10554For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10555@code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10556@samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10557expression
10558
10559@smallexample
10560(ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10561@end smallexample
10562
10563@noindent
10564can be converted to
10565
10566@smallexample
10567(ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10568@end smallexample
10569
10570@noindent
10571where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10572tested into the sign bit.
10573
10574There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10575for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10576but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
a3a15b4d 10577are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
feca2ed3 10578perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
b11cc610 10579comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
feca2ed3
JW
10580
10581Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10582from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10583choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10584to be used:
10585
10586@itemize @bullet
10587@item
10588Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10589@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10590``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10591comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10592combine the normalization with other operations.
10593
10594@item
630d3d5a 10595For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
feca2ed3
JW
10596slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10597other machines.
10598
10599@item
10600As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10601exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10602others.
10603
10604@item
10605Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10606@end itemize
10607
10608Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10609@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10610instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10611those cases, e.g., one matching
10612
10613@smallexample
10614(set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10615@end smallexample
10616
10617Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10618condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
ac5eda13 10619@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
feca2ed3
JW
10620machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10621and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10622@code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
2b0d3573 10623@file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptimizer can be used to
feca2ed3
JW
10624find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10625
06f31100
RS
10626If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10627not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10628instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
a2c4f8e0 10629@end defmac
feca2ed3 10630
a2c4f8e0 10631@defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
df2a54e9 10632A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
feca2ed3 10633returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
fc7ca5fd 10634Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
feca2ed3
JW
10635floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10636this macro.
a2c4f8e0 10637@end defmac
feca2ed3 10638
fc7ca5fd 10639@defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
a4d05547 10640A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
fc7ca5fd
RS
10641for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10642mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10643this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10644return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10645this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10646@code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10647the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10648given mode.
10649@end defmac
10650
a2c4f8e0
ZW
10651@defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10652@defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
14670a74 10653A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
ff2ce160 10654for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
14670a74
SL
10655A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10656If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10657evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10658entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
ff2ce160 10659the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
14670a74 10660In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
ff2ce160 10661this value.
14670a74
SL
10662
10663If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10664@code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
7dba8395
RH
10665
10666This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10667relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
14670a74
SL
10668is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10669to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
7dba8395
RH
10670
10671Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10672and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10673visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10674to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
8a36672b 10675breaking the API@.
a2c4f8e0 10676@end defmac
7dba8395 10677
a2c4f8e0 10678@defmac Pmode
feca2ed3
JW
10679An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10680this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10681pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10682On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10683modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10684
10685The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10686@code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10687@code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10688to @code{Pmode}.
a2c4f8e0 10689@end defmac
feca2ed3 10690
a2c4f8e0 10691@defmac FUNCTION_MODE
feca2ed3 10692An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
f71e957e 10693being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
ff2ce160 10694where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
f71e957e
DK
10695@code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10696size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10697as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
a2c4f8e0 10698@end defmac
feca2ed3 10699
a2c4f8e0 10700@defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
ee773fcc
NB
10701In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10702constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10703hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10704where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10705strict conformance to the C Standard.
10706
10707Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10708convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10709files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
a2c4f8e0 10710@end defmac
ee773fcc 10711
1efcb8c6
JM
10712@deftypefn {C Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_C_PREINCLUDE (void)
10713Define this hook to return the name of a header file to be included at the start of all compilations, as if it had been included with @code{#include <@var{file}>}. If this hook returns @code{NULL}, or is not defined, or the header is not found, or if the user specifies @option{-ffreestanding} or @option{-nostdinc}, no header is included.
10714
10715 This hook can be used together with a header provided by the system C library to implement ISO C requirements for certain macros to be predefined that describe properties of the whole implementation rather than just the compiler.
10716@end deftypefn
10717
88b0e79e
JC
10718@deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C (const char*@var{})
10719Define this hook to add target-specific C++ implicit extern C functions. If this function returns true for the name of a file-scope function, that function implicitly gets extern "C" linkage rather than whatever language linkage the declaration would normally have. An example of such function is WinMain on Win32 targets.
10720@end deftypefn
10721
a2c4f8e0 10722@defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
161d7b59 10723Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
feca2ed3
JW
10724This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10725C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10726@samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
a2c4f8e0 10727@end defmac
feca2ed3 10728
feca2ed3
JW
10729@findex #pragma
10730@findex pragma
a2c4f8e0 10731@defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
8b97c5f8 10732Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
a5da89c6 10733If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
b5b3e36a
DJ
10734@code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10735for each pragma. The macro may also do any
a5da89c6 10736setup required for the pragmas.
8b97c5f8
ZW
10737
10738The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10739other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
161d7b59 10740definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
feca2ed3 10741
c237e94a 10742If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
91d231cb 10743defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
f09db6e0 10744
8b97c5f8
ZW
10745Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
10746@samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
630d3d5a 10747silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
a2c4f8e0 10748@end defmac
8b97c5f8 10749
c58b209a 10750@deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
b5b3e36a 10751@deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
8b97c5f8 10752
b5b3e36a
DJ
10753Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10754@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
8b97c5f8
ZW
10755@var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10756pragma of the form
10757
10758@smallexample
10759#pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10760@end smallexample
10761
a5da89c6
NB
10762@var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10763@code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
10764routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
51fabca5 10765on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
75ce3d48 10766@var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
51fabca5 10767callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
b5b3e36a
DJ
10768a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
10769arguments of pragmas registered with
10770@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
10771pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
8b97c5f8 10772
75ce3d48 10773Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
aac69a49 10774compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
75ce3d48 10775other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
aac69a49 10776to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
c771326b 10777building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
aac69a49 10778variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
aee96fe9 10779target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
aac69a49 10780the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
75ce3d48 10781code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
aac69a49
NC
10782rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
10783how to build this object file.
8b97c5f8
ZW
10784@end deftypefun
10785
b5b3e36a 10786@defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
24a57808 10787Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
b5b3e36a
DJ
10788arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
10789@end defmac
10790
467cecf3
JB
10791@defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
10792If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
0bdcd332 10793the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
8b7d4300 10794This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
467cecf3
JB
10795@samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
10796@end defmac
10797
a2c4f8e0 10798@defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
b1822ccc 10799Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
170ea7b9 10800identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
b1822ccc
NB
10801not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
10802there is no need to define this macro in that case.
a2c4f8e0 10803@end defmac
feca2ed3 10804
a2c4f8e0 10805@defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
feca2ed3
JW
10806Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10807delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10808even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
a3a15b4d 10809@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
feca2ed3
JW
10810every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
10811or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
10812you should define this macro.
10813
10814You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
a2c4f8e0 10815@end defmac
feca2ed3 10816
a2c4f8e0 10817@defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
feca2ed3
JW
10818Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10819delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10820even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
10821@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
10822some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
10823are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
10824define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
10825instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
10826slot of @var{insn}.
10827
10828You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
a2c4f8e0 10829@end defmac
feca2ed3 10830
a2c4f8e0 10831@defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
15072eb1
ZW
10832Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
10833global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
10834symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
10835instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
10836from shared libraries (DLLs).
10837
10838You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
a2c4f8e0 10839@end defmac
861bb6c1 10840
7ca35180
RH
10841@deftypefn {Target Hook} {rtx_insn *} TARGET_MD_ASM_ADJUST (vec<rtx>& @var{outputs}, vec<rtx>& @var{inputs}, vec<const char *>& @var{constraints}, vec<rtx>& @var{clobbers}, HARD_REG_SET& @var{clobbered_regs})
10842This target hook may add @dfn{clobbers} to @var{clobbers} and
10843@var{clobbered_regs} for any hard regs the port wishes to automatically
10844clobber for an asm. The @var{outputs} and @var{inputs} may be inspected
10845to avoid clobbering a register that is already used by the asm.
10846
10847It may modify the @var{outputs}, @var{inputs}, and @var{constraints}
10848as necessary for other pre-processing. In this case the return value is
10849a sequence of insns to emit after the asm.
67dfe110 10850@end deftypefn
57bcb97a 10851
a2c4f8e0 10852@defmac MATH_LIBRARY
71d718e0 10853Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
d9d16a19
JM
10854in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
10855@samp{""} if the target does not have a
71d718e0
JM
10856separate math library.
10857
d9d16a19 10858You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
a2c4f8e0 10859@end defmac
512b62fb 10860
a2c4f8e0 10861@defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
512b62fb
JM
10862Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
10863specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
10864
10865You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
10866is wrong.
a2c4f8e0 10867@end defmac
e09d24ff 10868
4969c0d8
L
10869@defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
10870Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
10871functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
10872Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
e09d24ff 10873to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
4969c0d8 10874if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
709a840a 10875for cross-profiling.
a2c4f8e0 10876@end defmac
0c99ec5c 10877
a2c4f8e0 10878@defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
0c99ec5c
RH
10879
10880A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
10881conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
10882@code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
108831 if it does use cc0.
a2c4f8e0 10884@end defmac
90280148 10885
a2c4f8e0 10886@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
c05ffc49
BS
10887Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
10888conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
10889@var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
10890contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
10891and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
10892then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
10893@var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
a2c4f8e0 10894@end defmac
c05ffc49 10895
a2c4f8e0 10896@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
c05ffc49
BS
10897Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
10898if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
10899@var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
10900being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
a2c4f8e0 10901@end defmac
90280148 10902
a2c4f8e0 10903@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
c05ffc49
BS
10904A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
10905be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
10906a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
10907about the currently processed blocks.
a2c4f8e0 10908@end defmac
90280148 10909
a2c4f8e0 10910@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
90280148 10911A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
c05ffc49
BS
10912converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10913can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10914to by @var{ce_info}.
a2c4f8e0 10915@end defmac
90280148 10916
a2c4f8e0 10917@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
90280148 10918A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
c05ffc49
BS
10919converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10920can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10921to by @var{ce_info}.
a2c4f8e0 10922@end defmac
c05ffc49 10923
67a0732f
SB
10924@defmac IFCVT_MACHDEP_INIT (@var{ce_info})
10925A C expression to initialize any machine specific data for if-conversion
10926of the if-block in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10927to by @var{ce_info}.
a2c4f8e0 10928@end defmac
c05ffc49 10929
b6fd8800 10930@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG (void)
18dbd950
RS
10931If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
10932instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
10933just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
10934
10935The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
10936it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
10937laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
10938Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
10939
10940You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
10941definition is null.
10942@end deftypefn
10943
b6fd8800 10944@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS (void)
f6155fda
SS
10945Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10946that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
4a1d48f6
BS
10947necessary setup.
10948
c771326b 10949Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
4a1d48f6
BS
10950instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
10951they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
10952instructions or prefetch instructions).
10953
6e34d3a3
JM
10954To create a built-in function, call the function
10955@code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
c771326b 10956which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
1a072294 10957up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes};
c237e94a 10958only language front ends that use those two functions will call
f6155fda 10959@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
acdcefcc 10960@end deftypefn
4a1d48f6 10961
914d25dc 10962@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL (unsigned @var{code}, bool @var{initialize_p})
e9e4b3a8
RG
10963Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10964that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
10965builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
10966If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
10967if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
10968If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
10969@code{error_mark_node}.
10970@end deftypefn
10971
ef4bddc2 10972@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore})
4a1d48f6 10973
c771326b 10974Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
f6155fda
SS
10975@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
10976function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
10977convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
10978@var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
10979@var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
10980ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
10981built-in function.
acdcefcc 10982@end deftypefn
4a1d48f6 10983
d5e254e1
IE
10984@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_CHKP_FUNCTION (unsigned @var{fcode})
10985This hook allows target to redefine built-in functions used by
10986Pointer Bounds Checker for code instrumentation. Hook should return
10987fndecl of function implementing generic builtin whose code is
10988passed in @var{fcode}. Currently following built-in functions are
10989obtained using this hook:
10990@deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_bndmk (const void *@var{lb}, size_t @var{size})
10991Function code - BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDMK. This built-in function is used
10992by Pointer Bounds Checker to create bound values. @var{lb} holds low
10993bound of the resulting bounds. @var{size} holds size of created bounds.
10994@end deftypefn
10995
10996@deftypefn {Built-in Function} void __chkp_bndstx (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b}, const void **@var{loc})
10997Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDSTX}. This built-in function is used
10998by Pointer Bounds Checker to store bounds @var{b} for pointer @var{ptr}
10999when @var{ptr} is stored by address @var{loc}.
11000@end deftypefn
11001
11002@deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_bndldx (const void **@var{loc}, const void *@var{ptr})
11003Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDLDX}. This built-in function is used
11004by Pointer Bounds Checker to get bounds of pointer @var{ptr} loaded by
11005address @var{loc}.
11006@end deftypefn
11007
11008@deftypefn {Built-in Function} void __chkp_bndcl (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b})
11009Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDCL}. This built-in function is used
11010by Pointer Bounds Checker to perform check for pointer @var{ptr} against
11011lower bound of bounds @var{b}.
11012@end deftypefn
11013
11014@deftypefn {Built-in Function} void __chkp_bndcu (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b})
11015Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDCU}. This built-in function is used
11016by Pointer Bounds Checker to perform check for pointer @var{ptr} against
11017upper bound of bounds @var{b}.
11018@end deftypefn
11019
11020@deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_bndret (void *@var{ptr})
11021Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDRET}. This built-in function is used
11022by Pointer Bounds Checker to obtain bounds returned by a call statement.
11023@var{ptr} passed to built-in is @code{SSA_NAME} returned by the call.
11024@end deftypefn
11025
11026@deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_intersect (__bounds_type @var{b1}, __bounds_type @var{b2})
11027Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_INTERSECT}. This built-in function
11028returns intersection of bounds @var{b1} and @var{b2}.
11029@end deftypefn
11030
11031@deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_narrow (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b}, size_t @var{s})
11032Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_NARROW}. This built-in function
11033returns intersection of bounds @var{b} and
11034[@var{ptr}, @var{ptr} + @var{s} - @code{1}].
11035@end deftypefn
11036
11037@deftypefn {Built-in Function} size_t __chkp_sizeof (const void *@var{ptr})
11038Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_SIZEOF}. This built-in function
11039returns size of object referenced by @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} is always
11040@code{ADDR_EXPR} of @code{VAR_DECL}. This built-in is used by
11041Pointer Bounds Checker when bounds of object cannot be computed statically
11042(e.g. object has incomplete type).
11043@end deftypefn
11044
11045@deftypefn {Built-in Function} const void *__chkp_extract_lower (__bounds_type @var{b})
11046Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_EXTRACT_LOWER}. This built-in function
11047returns lower bound of bounds @var{b}.
11048@end deftypefn
11049
11050@deftypefn {Built-in Function} const void *__chkp_extract_upper (__bounds_type @var{b})
11051Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_EXTRACT_UPPER}. This built-in function
11052returns upper bound of bounds @var{b}.
11053@end deftypefn
11054@end deftypefn
11055@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CHKP_BOUND_TYPE (void)
11056Return type to be used for bounds
11057@end deftypefn
11058@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_CHKP_BOUND_MODE (void)
11059Return mode to be used for bounds.
11060@end deftypefn
11061@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CHKP_MAKE_BOUNDS_CONSTANT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{lb}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{ub})
11062Return constant used to statically initialize constant bounds
11063with specified lower bound @var{lb} and upper bounds @var{ub}.
11064@end deftypefn
11065@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CHKP_INITIALIZE_BOUNDS (tree @var{var}, tree @var{lb}, tree @var{ub}, tree *@var{stmts})
11066Generate a list of statements @var{stmts} to initialize pointer
11067bounds variable @var{var} with bounds @var{lb} and @var{ub}. Return
11068the number of generated statements.
11069@end deftypefn
11070
7a241624 11071@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN (unsigned int @var{loc}, tree @var{fndecl}, void *@var{arglist})
4268e4cf
PB
11072Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
11073was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
11074@emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
11075implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
11076declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
11077arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
11078complete expression that implements the operation, usually
11079another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
7a241624 11080@var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
4268e4cf
PB
11081@end deftypefn
11082
f311c3b4 11083@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{n_args}, tree *@var{argp}, bool @var{ignore})
a05a80fc
KH
11084Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
11085@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
f311c3b4
NF
11086built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
11087the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
ea679d55
JG
11088The result is another tree, valid for both GIMPLE and GENERIC,
11089containing a simplified expression for the call's result. If
11090@var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
11091@end deftypefn
11092
11093@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GIMPLE_FOLD_BUILTIN (gimple_stmt_iterator *@var{gsi})
11094Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up
11095by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{gsi} points to the gimple
11096statement holding the function call. Returns true if any change
11097was made to the GIMPLE stream.
d6c2b67d
PB
11098@end deftypefn
11099
3649b9b7
ST
11100@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPARE_VERSION_PRIORITY (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
11101This hook is used to compare the target attributes in two functions to
11102determine which function's features get higher priority. This is used
11103during function multi-versioning to figure out the order in which two
11104versions must be dispatched. A function version with a higher priority
11105is checked for dispatching earlier. @var{decl1} and @var{decl2} are
11106 the two function decls that will be compared.
11107@end deftypefn
11108
11109@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GET_FUNCTION_VERSIONS_DISPATCHER (void *@var{decl})
11110This hook is used to get the dispatcher function for a set of function
11111versions. The dispatcher function is called to invoke the right function
11112version at run-time. @var{decl} is one version from a set of semantically
11113identical versions.
11114@end deftypefn
11115
11116@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GENERATE_VERSION_DISPATCHER_BODY (void *@var{arg})
11117This hook is used to generate the dispatcher logic to invoke the right
11118function version at run-time for a given set of function versions.
11119@var{arg} points to the callgraph node of the dispatcher function whose
11120body must be generated.
11121@end deftypefn
11122
807e902e 11123@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_USE_DOLOOP_P (const widest_int @var{&iterations}, const widest_int @var{&iterations_max}, unsigned int @var{loop_depth}, bool @var{entered_at_top})
1d0216c8
RS
11124Return true if it is possible to use low-overhead loops (@code{doloop_end}
11125and @code{doloop_begin}) for a particular loop. @var{iterations} gives the
11126exact number of iterations, or 0 if not known. @var{iterations_max} gives
11127the maximum number of iterations, or 0 if not known. @var{loop_depth} is
11128the nesting depth of the loop, with 1 for innermost loops, 2 for loops that
11129contain innermost loops, and so on. @var{entered_at_top} is true if the
11130loop is only entered from the top.
11131
11132This hook is only used if @code{doloop_end} is available. The default
11133implementation returns true. You can use @code{can_use_doloop_if_innermost}
11134if the loop must be the innermost, and if there are no other restrictions.
11135@end deftypefn
11136
ac44248e 11137@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP (const rtx_insn *@var{insn})
a71a498d 11138
e7e64a25 11139Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
72392b81
JR
11140low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
11141could not be applied.
a71a498d 11142
e7e64a25
AS
11143Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
11144instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
083cad55 11145the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
a71a498d 11146By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
083cad55 11147loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
a71a498d
AS
11148@end deftypefn
11149
ac44248e 11150@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_COMBINED_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn})
78e4f1ad
UB
11151Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return @code{false} if the instruction is not appropriate as a combination of two or more instructions. The default is to accept all instructions.
11152@end deftypefn
11153
c1ce59ab 11154@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_FOLLOW_JUMP (const rtx_insn *@var{follower}, const rtx_insn *@var{followee})
4b4de898
JR
11155FOLLOWER and FOLLOWEE are JUMP_INSN instructions; return true if FOLLOWER may be modified to follow FOLLOWEE; false, if it can't. For example, on some targets, certain kinds of branches can't be made to follow through a hot/cold partitioning.
11156@end deftypefn
11157
914d25dc 11158@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P (const_rtx @var{x}, int @var{outer_code})
8ddf681a
R
11159This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
11160Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
0ee2ea09 11161PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
8ddf681a
R
11162of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
11163@end deftypefn
11164
b48f503c 11165@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE (rtx @var{hard_reg})
385b6e2d
R
11166
11167When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
4fe9b91c 11168register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
385b6e2d 11169to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
b48f503c
KK
11170it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
11171is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
11172that had its initial value copied by using
385b6e2d
R
11173@code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
11174Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
11175to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
11176the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
11177@code{MEM}.
11178If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
11179it might decide to use another register anyways.
29454ff5
SL
11180You may use @code{current_function_is_leaf} or
11181@code{REG_N_SETS} in the hook to determine if the hard
385b6e2d 11182register in question will not be clobbered.
b48f503c
KK
11183The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
11184allocation.
11185@end deftypefn
385b6e2d 11186
215b063c
PB
11187@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P (const_rtx @var{x}, unsigned @var{flags})
11188This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
11189@code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
11190this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
11191@code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
11192to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
11193passed along.
11194@end deftypefn
11195
db2960f4 11196@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION (tree @var{decl})
ff2ce160 11197The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
db2960f4
SL
11198context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
11199the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
11200per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
11201attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
11202The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
11203and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
11204and is returning to processing at the top level.
11205The default hook function does nothing.
11206
11207GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
11208some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
11209situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
11210or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
914d25dc
JR
11211@code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
11212outside of any function scope.
db2960f4
SL
11213@end deftypefn
11214
a2c4f8e0 11215@defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
807633e5
ZW
11216Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
11217files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
11218use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
a2c4f8e0 11219@end defmac
807633e5 11220
a2c4f8e0 11221@defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
807633e5
ZW
11222Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
11223automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
11224do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
11225executable files.
a2c4f8e0 11226@end defmac
807633e5 11227
a2c4f8e0 11228@defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
807633e5
ZW
11229If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
11230specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
11231Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
11232object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
11233lists.
a2c4f8e0 11234@end defmac
807633e5 11235
a2c4f8e0 11236@defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
55ae46b1
RM
11237Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
11238method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
11239must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
95fef11f 11240For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
55ae46b1
RM
11241the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
11242defined as this expression:
11243
11244@smallexample
11245build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
11246 build_tree_list
11247 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
11248 NULL))
11249@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 11250@end defmac
e4ec2cac
AO
11251
11252@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P (void)
11253This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
11254instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
11255every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
11256reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
11257
11258@smallexample
11259static bool
11260cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
11261@{
11262 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
11263@}
11264@end smallexample
11265@end deftypefn
fe3ad572 11266
a87cf97e 11267@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS (void)
fe3ad572
SC
11268This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
11269optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
c0cbdbd9 11270usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
fe3ad572
SC
11271re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
11272to inter-block scheduling.
11273@end deftypefn
11274
11275@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED (bool @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen})
11276Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
11277registers
11278that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
11279returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
11280that all target registers in the class returned by
11281@samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
11282saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
11283epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
11284true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
11285to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
11286to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
11287@end deftypefn
2082e02f 11288
2929029c
WG
11289@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION (void)
11290This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
11291This target hook is required only when the target has several different
11292modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
11293@end deftypefn
11294
5f3bc026
ZC
11295@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GEN_CCMP_FIRST (rtx *@var{prep_seq}, rtx *@var{gen_seq}, int @var{code}, tree @var{op0}, tree @var{op1})
11296This function prepares to emit a comparison insn for the first compare in a
11297 sequence of conditional comparisions. It returns a appropriate @code{CC}
11298 for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}. The insns to
11299 prepare the compare are saved in @var{prep_seq} and the compare insns are
11300 saved in @var{gen_seq}. They will be emitted when all the compares in the
11301 the conditional comparision are generated without error. @var{code} is
2e0f1341
ZC
11302 the @code{rtx_code} of the compare for @var{op0} and @var{op1}.
11303@end deftypefn
11304
5f3bc026
ZC
11305@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GEN_CCMP_NEXT (rtx *@var{prep_seq}, rtx *@var{gen_seq}, rtx @var{prev}, int @var{cmp_code}, tree @var{op0}, tree @var{op1}, int @var{bit_code})
11306This function prepare to emit a conditional comparison within a sequence of
11307 conditional comparisons. It returns a appropriate @code{CC} for passing to
11308 @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}. The insns to prepare the
11309 compare are saved in @var{prep_seq} and the compare insns are saved in
11310 @var{gen_seq}. They will be emitted when all the compares in the conditional
11311 comparision are generated without error. The @var{prev} expression is the
11312 result of a prior call to @code{gen_ccmp_first} or @code{gen_ccmp_next}. It
11313 may return @code{NULL} if the combination of @var{prev} and this comparison is
2e0f1341
ZC
11314 not supported, otherwise the result must be appropriate for passing to
11315 @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}. @var{code} is the
11316 @code{rtx_code} of the compare for @var{op0} and @var{op1}. @var{bit_code}
11317 is @code{AND} or @code{IOR}, which is the op on the two compares.
11318@end deftypefn
11319
40ac4f73
CB
11320@deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST (unsigned @var{nunroll}, struct loop *@var{loop})
11321This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
11322should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11323the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11324the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11325is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11326number of memory accesses.
11327@end deftypefn
11328
2082e02f 11329@defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
73774972 11330If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
2082e02f
RS
11331that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11332that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11333constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11334more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11335system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11336The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11337@end defmac
94d1613b 11338
3dd53121 11339@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
94d1613b
MS
11340This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11341target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
3dd53121
AP
11342are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11343The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11344@end deftypefn
11345
11346@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11347This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11348target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11349indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11350@var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11351@var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
94d1613b
MS
11352@end deftypefn
11353
11354@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11355This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11356The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11357systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11358that are different from @option{-I}.
11359@end deftypefn
4a77e08c 11360
914d25dc
JR
11361@defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11362This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
4a77e08c 11363for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
914d25dc 11364@code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
431ae0bf 11365functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
4a77e08c 11366@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
914d25dc 11367@end defmac
a2bec818
DJ
11368
11369@defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11370If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11371target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11372option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11373@end defmac
11374
11375@defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11376If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11377@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11378@end defmac
e50e6b88 11379
6590fc9f
KT
11380@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11381If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11382target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11383default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11384@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11385@end defmac
11386
11387@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11388If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11389@code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11390@end defmac
11391
94564826
KT
11392@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11393If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11394routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11395and scanf formatter settings.
11396@end defmac
11397
b6fd8800 11398@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN (const_tree @var{typelist}, const_tree @var{funcdecl}, const_tree @var{val})
083cad55
EC
11399If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11400illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
4d3e6fae
FJ
11401with prototype @var{typelist}.
11402@end deftypefn
11403
b6fd8800 11404@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION (const_tree @var{fromtype}, const_tree @var{totype})
4de67c26
JM
11405If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11406invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11407if validity should be determined by the front end.
11408@end deftypefn
11409
b6fd8800 11410@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type})
4de67c26
JM
11411If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11412invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11413@code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11414if validity should be determined by the front end.
11415@end deftypefn
11416
b6fd8800 11417@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
4de67c26
JM
11418If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11419invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11420and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11421the front end.
11422@end deftypefn
11423
b6fd8800 11424@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_PARAMETER_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
40449a90 11425If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
ff2ce160 11426invalid for functions to include parameters of type @var{type},
40449a90
SL
11427or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11428the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11429@end deftypefn
11430
b6fd8800 11431@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_RETURN_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
40449a90 11432If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
ff2ce160 11433invalid for functions to have return type @var{type},
40449a90
SL
11434or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11435the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11436@end deftypefn
11437
b6fd8800 11438@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
ff2ce160
MS
11439If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11440@var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
40449a90
SL
11441analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11442front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11443target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11444This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11445@end deftypefn
11446
b6fd8800 11447@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE (tree @var{type}, tree @var{expr})
ff2ce160
MS
11448If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11449@var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
40449a90 11450or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
ff2ce160 11451This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
40449a90
SL
11452conversion rules.
11453This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11454@end deftypefn
11455
e50e6b88
DS
11456@defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
11457This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
11458classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
11459SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
11460@end defmac
64ee9490
EC
11461
11462@defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11463This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11464NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11465@end defmac
56e449d3
SL
11466
11467@defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11468Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
ff2ce160 11469to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
56e449d3
SL
11470call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11471and the associated definitions of those functions.
11472@end defmac
007e61c2 11473
2e3f842f
L
11474@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY (void)
11475Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11476necessary.
11477@end deftypefn
11478
11479@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX (void)
914d25dc 11480This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
2e3f842f 11481different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
914d25dc
JR
11482argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11483is needed.
2e3f842f
L
11484@end deftypefn
11485
b6fd8800 11486@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS (void)
007e61c2
PB
11487When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11488arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11489stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11490debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11491@code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11492cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11493to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11494false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11495@end deftypefn
2c5bfdf7 11496
2c5bfdf7
AN
11497@deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11498On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11499a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11500is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11501is computed from this register using immediate addition or
a4ce9883 11502subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
2c5bfdf7
AN
11503the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11504available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11505constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11506down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11507@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11508accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11509value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11510MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11511@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
0d8aa4b1
AS
11512is zero, which disables this optimization.
11513@end deftypevr
57c5ab1b 11514
dfe06d3e
JJ
11515@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_ASAN_SHADOW_OFFSET (void)
11516Return the offset bitwise ored into shifted address to get corresponding
11517Address Sanitizer shadow memory address. NULL if Address Sanitizer is not
11518supported by the target.
11519@end deftypefn
11520
5dcfdccd
KY
11521@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_MEMMODEL_CHECK (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{val})
11522Validate target specific memory model mask bits. When NULL no target specific
11523memory model bits are allowed.
11524@end deftypefn
11525
57c5ab1b
RH
11526@deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_ATOMIC_TEST_AND_SET_TRUEVAL
11527This value should be set if the result written by @code{atomic_test_and_set} is not exactly 1, i.e. the @code{bool} @code{true}.
11528@end deftypevr
2f251a05
AI
11529
11530@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAS_IFUNC_P (void)
11531It returns true if the target supports GNU indirect functions.
11532The support includes the assembler, linker and dynamic linker.
11533The default value of this hook is based on target's libc.
11534@end deftypefn
267bac10 11535
ef4bddc2 11536@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_ATOMIC_ALIGN_FOR_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
fceec4d3
AM
11537If defined, this function returns an appropriate alignment in bits for an atomic object of machine_mode @var{mode}. If 0 is returned then the default alignment for the specified mode is used.
11538@end deftypefn
11539
267bac10
JM
11540@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ATOMIC_ASSIGN_EXPAND_FENV (tree *@var{hold}, tree *@var{clear}, tree *@var{update})
11541ISO C11 requires atomic compound assignments that may raise floating-point exceptions to raise exceptions corresponding to the arithmetic operation whose result was successfully stored in a compare-and-exchange sequence. This requires code equivalent to calls to @code{feholdexcept}, @code{feclearexcept} and @code{feupdateenv} to be generated at appropriate points in the compare-and-exchange sequence. This hook should set @code{*@var{hold}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feholdexcept}, @code{*@var{clear}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feclearexcept} and @code{*@var{update}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feupdateenv}. The three expressions are @code{NULL_TREE} on entry to the hook and may be left as @code{NULL_TREE} if no code is required in a particular place. The default implementation leaves all three expressions as @code{NULL_TREE}. The @code{__atomic_feraiseexcept} function from @code{libatomic} may be of use as part of the code generated in @code{*@var{update}}.
11542@end deftypefn
807e902e 11543
ec6fe917
IV
11544@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_RECORD_OFFLOAD_SYMBOL (tree)
11545Used when offloaded functions are seen in the compilation unit and no named
11546sections are available. It is called once for each symbol that must be
11547recorded in the offload function and variable table.
11548@end deftypefn
11549
c713ddc0
BS
11550@deftypefn {Target Hook} {char *} TARGET_OFFLOAD_OPTIONS (void)
11551Used when writing out the list of options into an LTO file. It should
11552translate any relevant target-specific options (such as the ABI in use)
11553into one of the @option{-foffload} options that exist as a common interface
11554to express such options. It should return a string containing these options,
11555separated by spaces, which the caller will free.
11556
11557@end deftypefn
11558
807e902e
KZ
11559@defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT
11560
11561On older ports, large integers are stored in @code{CONST_DOUBLE} rtl
11562objects. Newer ports define @code{TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT} to be nonzero
11563to indicate that large integers are stored in
11564@code{CONST_WIDE_INT} rtl objects. The @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} allows
11565very large integer constants to be represented. @code{CONST_DOUBLE}
11566is limited to twice the size of the host's @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}
11567representation.
11568
11569Converting a port mostly requires looking for the places where
11570@code{CONST_DOUBLE}s are used with @code{VOIDmode} and replacing that
11571code with code that accesses @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}s. @samp{"grep -i
11572const_double"} at the port level gets you to 95% of the changes that
11573need to be made. There are a few places that require a deeper look.
11574
11575@itemize @bullet
11576@item
11577There is no equivalent to @code{hval} and @code{lval} for
11578@code{CONST_WIDE_INT}s. This would be difficult to express in the md
11579language since there are a variable number of elements.
11580
11581Most ports only check that @code{hval} is either 0 or -1 to see if the
11582value is small. As mentioned above, this will no longer be necessary
11583since small constants are always @code{CONST_INT}. Of course there
11584are still a few exceptions, the alpha's constraint used by the zap
11585instruction certainly requires careful examination by C code.
11586However, all the current code does is pass the hval and lval to C
11587code, so evolving the c code to look at the @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} is
11588not really a large change.
11589
11590@item
11591Because there is no standard template that ports use to materialize
11592constants, there is likely to be some futzing that is unique to each
11593port in this code.
11594
11595@item
11596The rtx costs may have to be adjusted to properly account for larger
11597constants that are represented as @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}.
11598@end itemize
11599
11600All and all it does not take long to convert ports that the
11601maintainer is familiar with.
11602
11603@end defmac